Official Software
Get notified when we add a new VauxhallAstra Manual

We cover 60 Vauxhall vehicles, were you looking for one of these?

Vauxhall - Combo - Workshop Manual - 200 - 2012
Vauxhall - Corsa - Workshop Manual - (1991)
Vauxhall Vauxhall Zafira 2007 Vauxhall Zafira Owners Manual
Vauxhall Vauxhall Combo 2006 Vauxhall Combo Owners Manual
Vauxhall Vauxhall Meriva 2007 Vauxhall Meriva Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Corsa - Owners Manual - 2011 - 2011
Vauxhall - Antara - Workshop Manual - (2006)
Vauxhall - Vectra - Workshop Manual - 2002 - 2002
Vauxhall Vauxhall Antara 2009 Vauxhall Antara Owners Manual
Vauxhall Vauxhall Meriva 2010 Vauxhall Meriva Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Corsa - Workshop Manual - 1988 - 1992.PDF
Vauxhall - Meriva - Owners Manual - 2012 - 2012
Vauxhall Vauxhall Agila 2006 Vauxhall Agila Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Corsa - Owners Manual - 2013 - 2013
Vauxhall Vauxhall Movano 2008 Vauxhall Movano Owners Manual
Vauxhall Vauxhall Antara 2011 Vauxhall Antara Owners Manual
Vauxhall Vauxhall Insignia 2013 Vauxhall Insignia Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Corsa - Sales Brochure - 2007 - 2007 (2)
Vauxhall - Nova - Workshop Manual - (1992)
Vauxhall - Combo - Parts Catalogue - (2008)
RVs & Accessories - Winnebago - 2007 Vectra
Vauxhall Vauxhall Combo 2013 Vauxhall Combo Owners Manual
Vauxhall Vauxhall tigra 2009 Vauxhall Tigra Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Antara - Owners Manual - 2013 - 2013 (2)
Vauxhall Vauxhall Meriva 2014 Vauxhall Meriva Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Zafira - Miscellaneous Documents - 2009 - 2009
Vauxhall - Movano - Workshop Manual - 2016 - 2016
Vauxhall - Corsa - Miscellaneous Documents - 2014 - 2014
Vauxhall - Movano - Workshop Manual - 2005 - 2005 (2)
Vauxhall - Corsa - Owners Manual - 2013 - 2013 (2)
Vauxhall Vauxhall Antara 2014 Vauxhall Antara Owners Manual
Vauxhall Vauxhall Agila 2010 Vauxhall Agila Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Combo - Owners Manual - 2013 - 2013
Vauxhall - Combo - Owners Manual - 2012 - 2012
Vauxhall - Antara - Owners Manual - 2014 - 2014
Vauxhall - Antara - Sales Brochure - 2012 - 2012
Vauxhall - Meriva - Owners Manual - 2016 - 2016
Ford - Victoria - Parts Catalogue - 1935 - 1935
Vauxhall - Tigra - Sales Brochure - (2006)
Vauxhall - Calibra - Workshop Manual - 1994 - 1994
Vauxhall - Movano - Workshop Manual - 2005 - 2005
RVs & Accessories - Vectra - 1997 Vectra Grand Tour
Vauxhall Vauxhall Vivaro 2013 Vauxhall Vivaro Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Corsa - Sales Brochure - (2011)
RVs & Accessories - Vectra - 1997 Vectra
Bultaco - Motorcycle - Bultaco_Frontera_74_5d8a7f8219aab8a12373568
RVs & Accessories - Vectra - 1996 Vectra
Vauxhall - Antara - Sales Brochure - (2008)
Vauxhall - Omega - Workshop Manual - (2010)
Vauxhall - Corsa - Sales Brochure - 2010 - 2010
Vauxhall - Corsa - Sales Brochure - (2020)
Vauxhall Vauxhall Movano 2013 Vauxhall Movano Owners Manual
RVs & Accessories - Winnebago - 1993 Vectra
Vauxhall - Frontera - Miscellaneous Documents - (1998).PDF
BSA - Motorcycle - BSA_B25T_Victor_Trail_-_B25_SS_Gol_Star_250_Street_Scrambler_1971-Parts_List_Manual
Vauxhall Vauxhall Ampera 2013 Vauxhall Ampera Owners Manual
Vauxhall - Agila - Sales Brochure - (2006)
Vauxhall - Antara - Sales Brochure - 2007 - 2007
Bultaco - Motorcycle - Bultaco_Frontera_74
Faucets - Hansgrohe - Raindance Royale S 350 AIR 1-Jet Showerhea
Summary of Content
Owner’s Manual ASTRA Operation, Safety and Maintenance Reproduction or translation, in whole or in parts, is not permitted without prior written consent from Vauxhall Motors Ltd. All rights as understood under the copyright laws are explicitly reserved by Vauxhall Motors Ltd. All information, illustrations and specifications contained in this manual are based on the latest production information available at the time of publication. The right is reserved to make changes at any time without notice. Edition: January 2006. TS 1612-B-06 A ST R A ©Copyright by Vauxhall Motors Ltd., England. VAUXHALL Astra Owner’s Manual Seite -2, , Bearbeitung 19.12.05 Data specific to your vehicle Please enter your vehicle’s data here to keep it easily accessible. This information is available under the section "Technical data" as well as on the identification plate. Fuel Designation Engine oil Grade Viscosity Tyre inflation pressure Tyre size with up to 3 persons with full load Summer tyres front rear front rear Winter tyres front rear front rear Weights Permissible Gross Vehicle Weight – EC kerbweight = Loading Seite -1, , Bearbeitung 19.12.05 Your Astra Developed according to the latest findings of vehicle research, it offers technical sophistication and exceptional comfort. Your Astra represents an intelligent synthesis of advanced technology, outstanding safety, environmental compatibility and economy. It now lies with you to drive your Astra safely and to see it performs perfectly. This Owner’s Manual provides you with all the necessary information to that end. Make sure your passengers are aware of the possible risk of accident and injury which may result from improper use of the vehicle. The Owner’s Manual should always be kept in the vehicle: ready to hand in the glove compartment. Make use of the Owner’s Manual: z Its "In brief" section will give you an initial overview. z The table of contents at the beginning of the owner’s manual and within the individual chapters will show you where everything is. z Its index will help you find what you want. z It will familiarise you with the sophisticated technology. z It will increase your pleasure in your vehicle. z It will help you to handle your vehicle expertly. The Owner’s Manual is designed to be clearly laid-out and easily understood. This symbol signifies: 6 Continue reading on next page. 3 The asterisk signifies: equipment not fitted to all vehicles (model variants, engine options, models specific to one country, optional equipment, Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories). 9 Warning Text marked 9 Warning provides information on risk of accident or injury. Disregard of the instructions may lead to injuries or endanger life. Inform your passengers accordingly. Yellow arrows in the illustrations serve as points of reference or indicate some action to be performed. Black arrows in the illustrations indicate a reaction or a second action to be performed. We wish you many hours of pleasurable driving Your Vauxhall Team Seite 0, , Bearbeitung 20.12.05 Contents Commitment to customer satisfaction: Our aim: to keep you happy with your vehicle. All Vauxhall Authorised Repairers offer first class service at competitive prices. Experienced, factory-trained technicians work according to factory instructions. Your Authorised Repairer can supply you with GENUINE VAUXHALLAPPROVED PARTS, which have undergone stringent quality and precision checks, and of course useful and attractive VAUXHALL-APPROVED ACCESSORIES. Our name is your guarantee! For details of the Vauxhall Authorised Repairer Network please ring this number; 01582 - 427200 In brief ....................................................... 2 Instruments ............................................. 36 Keys, doors, bonnet .............................. 66 Seats, Interior .......................................... 87 Safety systems ..................................... 109 Lighting ................................................. 134 Windows, sunroof ................................ 141 TwinTop ................................................ 146 Climate control .................................... 153 Easytronic ............................................. 174 Automatic transmission ...................... 182 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect .............................. 188 Driving hints ......................................... 196 Saving fuel, protecting the environment ............ 198 Fuel consumption, fuel, refuelling .................................. 200 Catalytic converter, exhaust gases .... 203 Drive control systems .......................... 208 Brakes .................................................... 222 Wheels, tyres ......................................... 226 Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing ............. 234 Self-help ................................................ 243 If you have a problem ......................... 288 Maintenance, inspection system ........ 290 Vehicle care .......................................... 302 Technical data .................................... 306 Index ...................................................... 342 2 In brief In brief Picture no: 17027t.tif Key numbers, code numbers Remove key number from keys. The key number is specified in the vehicle documents and in the Car Pass. Alloy wheels 3, towing equipment 3: make a note of the key identifier codes. Electronic immobiliser, Infotainment system 3: the code numbers are specified in the Car Pass. Do not keep the Car Pass in the vehicle. For key with retractable key blade 3, press button to extend. 6 Further information – see pages 66, 67, vehicle recommissioning – see page 301. Picture no: 16968t.tif To unlock and open the vehicle: Press button q, pull door handle In vehicles with an Open&Start system 3, the vehicle is unlocked automatically by pulling a door handle or by operating the button beneath the tailgate handle, if the electronic key is in the external reception range of the vehicle. 6 Door locks, child safety locks – see page 86, electronic immobiliser – see page 67, keys – see page 66, Open&Start system 3 – see page 70, radio frequency remote control – see page 68, central locking system – see page 76, anti-theft locking system – see page 76, Vauxhall alarm system 3 – see page 83, TwinTop roof operation 3 – see page 146. In brief Picture no: 16969t.tif To unlock and open the luggage compartment: Press button q on remote control and operate button beneath handle In vehicles with Open&Start system 3 the tailgate is unlocked automatically by operating the button beneath the handle if the electronic key is within the external reception range of the vehicle. The doors are also unlocked. 6 Open&Start-System 3 – see page 70, radio frequency remote control – see page 68, central locking system – see page 76, Vauxhall alarm system 3 – see page 83. Picture no: 16970t.tif To adjust front seat: Pull handle, slide seat, release handle Never adjust the front seat while driving. It could move in an uncontrolled manner when the handle is pulled. 6 Seating position – see page 87. 9 Warning Important: Do not sit nearer than 10 inches (25 cm) from the steering wheel, to permit safe airbag deployment. Picture no: 16971t.tif To adjust front seat backrest: Turn handwheel Move backrest to suit seating position. Do not lean on seat backrest whilst adjusting it. 6 Seating position – see page 87. 3 4 In brief Picture no: 16972t.tif Picture no: 16973t.tif To adjust front seat lumbar support 3: Turn handwheel To adjust front seat height 3: Operate lever on outboard side of seat Adjust lumbar support to suit personal requirements. Lever pumping action upward: seat higher downward: seat lower Do not lean on seat backrest whilst adjusting it. 6 Seating position – see page 87. 6 Seating position – see page 87. Picture no: 16974t.tif To adjust front seat inclination 3: Pull inner lever on front of seat, adjust inclination, release lever, engage seat in position Adjust the inclination by distributing body weight. 6 Seating position – see page 87. In brief Picture no: 16975t.tif To fold the front seat backrest forward 3: Lift release lever, fold backrest forward and lock, slide seat forward To raise seat, slide back to stop, lift release lever and raise backrest. In front seats with memory-function 3, the seat engages in its original position when pushed back. In front seats without memory function 3, engage seat in required position when pushing backwards. Panoramic windscreen 3: before folding the seat, push the head restraints down and close the sunvisors. 6 Seating position – see page 87. Picture no: 17959t.tif To adjust thigh support 3 of the front sport seat 3: Press button in recessed handle centred in the lower half of the adjustment cushion and adjust the thigh support Adjust thigh support to suit personal requirements. Picture no: 16976t.tif 5 To adjust head restraint height of front and rear outboard seats: Press button to release, adjust height, engage in position 6 Adjusting centre rear head restraint – see page 88, head restraint position – see page 88, head restraint removal – see page 88. 6 In brief Picture no: 16977t.tif Adjusting interior mirror: Swivel mirror housing Swivel lever on underside of mirror housing to reduce dazzle at night. 6 Automatic anti-dazzle interior mirror – see page 132. Picture no: 16978t.tif Picture no: 18021T.tif To adjust exterior mirrors: From inside, swivel lever in required direction Electrical exterior mirrors 3, adjust: Four-way switch in driver’s door 6 Further information, aspherical exterior mirror 3 – see page 132. Press mirror switch right or left: four-way switch adjusts corresponding mirror. 6 Further information, aspherical exterior mirror – see page 132, heated exterior mirrors – see page 18. In brief Picture no: 16980t.tif Swing-in exterior mirror: Manually: press lightly. Electrically 3: press n and both mirrors will swing in. Press button n again - both exterior mirrors swivel to the driving position. If an electrical retracted mirror is extended manually, pressing button n will cause the mirror to move all the way forward. The other mirror will be electrically swivelled to the driving position. If button n is pressed again, both mirrors will be electrically retracted. Press again: both mirrors swivel to the driving position. Picture no: 16981t.tif 7 Picture no: 17328t.tif Fitting seat belt: Draw seat belt smoothly from inertia reel, guide over shoulder and engage in buckle Steering wheel adjustment: Move lever down, adjust height and distance, move lever up, engage The belt must not be twisted at any point. The lap belt must lie snugly against the body. The backrest must not be tilted back too far (recommended maximum tilting angle approx. 25°). Adjust steering wheel only when vehicle is stationary and steering column lock is released. To release belt, press red button on belt buckle. 6 Seat belt – see page 110, airbag systems – see page 115, seating position – see page 87. 6 Airbag systems – see page 115. 8 In brief In brief 1 Page Side air vents .................................. 155 8 Page Instruments ....................................... 36 2 Front passenger’s airbag ............. 116 9 Horn .................................................. 16 3 Centre air vents ............................. 155 4 Central Information Display for time, date, outside temperature, Infotainment system 3, check control 3 ................................ 62 Trip computer 3 .........................52, 58 Electronic Climate Control 3 ....... 167 10 Windscreen wiper, windscreen wash system, headlight wash system 3 and rear window wash system ......... 17, 18 5 Heated seat (left) 3 ...................... 156 Deflation Detection System 3 ....... 217 Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 ......................................... 218 Parking distance sensors 3 .......... 214 Hazard warning lights ..................... 16 Central locking system .................... 78 SPORT mode 3 ............................... 210 Heated seat (right) 3 .................... 156 6 Turn signal lights, headlight flash dipped beam, main beam .............. 15 Door-to-door lighting function ...... 138 Parking lights 3 ............................. 138 Cruise control 3 ....................... 13, 212 7 Remote control 3 for Infotainment system ........................ 64 99 Page 13 Starter switch with electronic immobiliser .................... 14 and sensor panel for emergency operation Open&Start system 3 ... 73 14 Accelerator pedal.................. 196, 197 11 Parking lights, dipped beam ........ 134 Instrument illumination ................. 138 Fog tail light ................................... 135 Front fog lights 3 ........................... 135 Headlight range adjustment 3 .... 136 15 Brake pedal ................... 197, 222, 223 12 Bonnet release lever ........................ 86 19 Ashtray 3 ....................................... 106 Cigarette lighter 3 ........................ 105 16 Clutch pedal 3 ............................... 197 17 Steering wheel adjustment ............... 7 18 Start / Stop button 3 ................ 22, 70 20 Climate control ............................. 153 21 Infotainment system 3.................... 65 22 Glove compartment ....... 72, 108, 155 10 In brief Q Door open, see page 38. S Open&Start system 3, see pages 36, 70. Engine oil level 3, see pages 39, 292. p 8 Engine oil pressure, see page 37. Alternator, see page 39. Exterior lights, see pages 39, 134. W Coolant temperature, see pages 39, 294. r Parking distance sensors 3, see page 214. A Engine electronics, Transmission electronics 3, Electronic immobiliser, Diesel fuel filter 3, Fault, see pages 39, 67, 180, 186, 194, 206. O Turn signal lights, see pages 15, 40. Y Fuel level, see pages 40, 45, 201. > Front fog lights 3, see pages 40, 135. C Main beam, see pages 15, 40. r Fog tail light, see pages 40, 135. Control indicators 0 I R Brake system, clutch system, see pages 38, 222, 296. v Airbag systems, belt tensioners, deployable anti-roll bar 3, see pages 112, 121, 130. v Electronic Stability Programme (ESP®Plus) 3, see page 208. X Seat belt 3, see pages 38, 113. IDS+ Interactive Driving System 3, Continuous Damping Control 3, SPORT mode 3, see pages 210, 211. In brief T 1 Winter programme of automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3, see pages 177, 185, 192. SPORT mode of automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3, see pages 176, 184, 191. y Seat occupancy recognition 3, see page 122. Z Exhaust emission 3, see pages 41, 205. u Anti-lock Brake System, see page 225. ! Preheating system 3, Diesel particle filter 3, see page 42. w B m Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3, tyre pressure monitoring system 3, see pages 42, 217, 220. Adaptive Forward Lighting 3 (AFL), Fault, see pages 137, 140. Cruise control 3, see pages 13, 212. Lighting Light switch, switch positions, see pages 14, 134, 7 8 9 Lights off, > Front fog lights 3, see page 135. r Fog tail light, see page 135. C Main beam, see page 15. O Turn signal lights, see page 15. k Instrument illumination, see page 138. c Courtesy light, see page 139. a Reading lights 3, see page 139. ¨ Hazard warning lights, see page 16. Parking lights, Dipped beam, main beam. 11 12 In brief Climate control Air distribution, see pages 157, 171, n Air conditioning system 3, see pages 19, 160, 164. 4 Sunroof 3 ü Air recirculation system 3, see pages 160, 164, 172. Sunroof, opening or tilting – see page 145. d Sunroof, closing – see page 145. L to head area via adjustable air vents and to footwell, M to head area via adjustable air vents, AUTO G l Automatic mode 3, see pages 19, 168. to windscreen, J V to windscreen and to footwell, Demisting and defrosting 3, see pages 19, 159, 162, 170. Sunblind, opening – see page 145. H K to footwell. ß Heated front seats 3, see page 156. Sunblind, closing – see page 145. Windscreen wiper x Airflow, see pages 157, 171. A Ü Automatic control of fan speed 3, see page 164. Heated rear window, see pages 18, 156. Stalk positions, see pages 17, 18, Astra TwinTop 3 > Open roof, see page 147. < Close roof, see page 147. " Central switch window operation, opening, see page 142. " Central switch window operation, closing, see page 142. § $ Off, % & Slow, Timed interval wipe, or automatic wipe with rain sensor 3, Fast. In brief Cruise control 3 m g § E Deflation Detection System 3, tyre pressure monitoring system 3, see pages 217, 218. Central locking system, unlocking, see page 78. r m Parking distance sensors 3, see page 214. Central locking switch, see page 78. SPORT b SPORT mode 3, see page 210. Vauxhall alarm system 3, see page 83. T 0 Emergency operation Open&Start system, see page 73. Winter programme, Easytronic 3, automatic transmission 3, see pages 177, 185, 192. z j Child safety system for rear windows 3, see page 142. Horn, see page 16. + First-aid kit (cushion) 3, see page 248. ¨ Warning triangle 3, see page 248. Miscellaneous Buttons on turn signal stalk, see pages 16, 212. p Central locking system, locking, see page 76. Activate, store, accelerate, q resume stored speed, decelerate, deactivate. Information display, Infotainment system Information display, see page 46. Ö On button for date and time: see page 48. ; Setting buttons for date and time: see page 48. Remote control for Infotainment system 3, see pages 49, 64. 13 14 In brief Picture no: 16982t.tif Steering column lock and ignition: Turn key to position 1; release steering column lock by moving the steering wheel slightly Positions: 0 = Ignition off 1 = Steering released, ignition off 2 = Ignition on, with diesel engine: preheating 3 = Start To lock the steering wheel, switch ignition off, remove key and engage steering wheel. 6 Starting – see page 22, electronic immobiliser – see page 67, parking the vehicle – see page 24. Picture no: 17033t.tif Steering column lock and ignition on vehicles with Open&Start system 3: Make sure electronic key is inside the car and press the Start / Stop button; release steering column lock by moving the steering wheel slightly To start the vehicle, also operate brake or clutch pedal. To lock the steering wheel, switch ignition off by pressing the Start / Stop button, open driver’s door and engage steering wheel. Do not allow vehicle to move whilst doing this. 6 Starting – see page 22, electronic immobiliser – see page 67, parking the vehicle – see page 24. Picture no: 16986t.tif Light switch: 7 = Off 8 = Parking lights 9 = Dipped or main beam AUTO = Daytime running lights 3 Press > = Front fog lights 3 Press r = Fog tail light 6 Further information – see page 134, headlight warning device – see page 23. In brief Picture no: 16987t.tif Dipped and main beam switch: Main beam = Push stalk forward Dipped beam = Push stalk forward again or pull toward steering wheel The blue control indicator C is illuminated when main beam is on. Picture no: 16988t.tif Headlight flash: Pull stalk towards steering wheel 15 Picture no: 16989t.tif To operate turn signal lights: Right = Move stalk up Left = Move stalk down After operation, the turn signal stalk returns to its starting position. If the stalk is moved past the resistance point, the turn signal light remains on. When the steering wheel moves back toward the straight-ahead position, the turn signal light is automatically deactivated. Tap signal: move stalk to resistance point and release to activate three flashes from the turn signals when changing lanes or the like. Move the stalk to the resistance point and hold for the turn signals to flash longer. Switch the turn signal off manually by moving the stalk slightly. 16 In brief Picture no: 16990t.tif Picture no: 16991t.tif Picture no: 16992t.tif Cruise control operation 3: Press button on stalk Hazard warning lights: On = Press ¨ Off = Press ¨ again Activate horn: Press j in centre of steering wheel Switch off: briefly press button §. To aid location of the pushbutton, the red surface is illuminated when the ignition is switched on. When the button is pressed, its control indicator flashes in time with the hazard warning lights. 6 Airbag systems – see page 115, Steering wheel mounted remote control buttons for Infotainment system 3 – see page 64. Switch on: briefly press button m. Resume at stored speed: briefly press button g. 6 Cruise control 3 – see page 212. In brief Picture no: 16993t.tif Windscreen wiper: Move stalk upward § = Off $ = Adjustable timed interval wipe % = Slow & = Fast Stalk always moves back to starting position. Shift to next higher or lower level: move stalk slightly. Push stalk past resistance point and hold: the windscreen wiper stages are run through; an acoustic signal sounds at position §. Press stalk down from position §: single swipe. 6 Further information – see pages 297, 304. Picture no: 16994t.tif Windscreen wiper: Adjustable timed interval wiper To set the wiper interval to a value between 2 and 15 seconds: Switch on ignition. Press stalk down from position §. Wait the desired interval. Set the stalk to timed interval wipe $. The interval remains stored until the next change or the ignition is switched off. Switching the ignition on and moving the stalk to $ sets the interval to 4 seconds. 17 Picture no: 16995t.tif Automatic wiping with rain sensor 3: Move stalk upward $ = Automatic wiping with rain sensor Automatic wiping $: the rain sensor detects the amount of water on the windscreen and automatically regulates the windscreen wiper. To switch off, move stalk downwards. 6 Further information – see pages 297, 304. 18 In brief Picture no: 16996t.tif Operating windscreen and headlight wash systems 3: Pull stalk towards steering wheel The wiper swipes for a few strokes. At low speeds, there is a single post-wash swipe. The headlight wash system 3 can be operated when the lights are on. Wash fluid is sprayed on the headlights. The headlight wash system cannot be operated for 2 minutes thereafter. Picture no: 16997t.tif To operate rear window wiper 3 and wash system 3: Wiper on = Push stalk forward Wiper off = Push stalk forward again Wash = Press and hold The rear window wiper swipes in timed interval mode. On vehicles fitted with rain sensor 3, keep the sensor area clean by operating the wash system regularly. The rear window wiper engages automatically when the windscreen wiper is switched on and reverse gear is engaged. 6 Further information – see pages 297, 304. 6 Further information – see pages 297, 304. Picture no: 16998t.tif Heated rear window, heated exterior mirrors: On = Press Ü Off = Press Ü again Heating operational only with engine running. The rear window and exterior mirror heating is switched off automatically after approx. 15 minutes. 6 Further information – see page 156. In brief Range Inst. consumpt. 19,5° Picture no: 16999t.tif To demist or defrost windows: Set air distribution to l, rotary knob for temperature and airflow clockwise; Air conditioning system 3: Also press button n; Automatic air conditioning system 3: Press button n and v, turn rotary knob for temperature clockwise, airflow to A; Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3: Press button V Open air vents and direct the side air vents toward the door windows. 6 Climate control – see page 153. Picture no: 17000t.tif To set automatic mode of Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3: Press AUTO button, set temperature using rotary knob Open all air vents. 6 Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 – see page 167. 23° 5 19 257 miles 7.6 miles/gal Eco x 19:36 Picture no: 17329t.tif Information display 3: Provides information: – – – – – – – – time, outside temperature, radio 3 and date, navigation 3, telephone 3, check control 3, trip computer 3, Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3. 6 Information Display 3 – see page 46. 20 In brief Picture no: 17001t.tif Manual transmission: Reverse: with the vehicle stationary, wait 3 seconds after declutching and then pull up the button on the selector lever and engage the gear. If the gear does not engage, set the lever in neutral, release the clutch pedal and depress again; then repeat gear selection. Picture no: 17002t.tif Easytronic 3: N = Neutral (idle) o = Drive position + = Higher gear = Lower gear A = Change between automatic and manual mode R = Reverse (with selector lever lock) The selector lever must always be moved in the appropriate direction as far as it will go. Upon release, it automatically returns to the centre position. Pay heed to the gear / mode indicator in the transmission display. The foot brake must be depressed when starting. 6 Easytronic – see page 174. Picture no: 17003t.tif Automatic transmission 3: P = Park R = Reverse N = Neutral (idle) D = Automatic gear selection 3 = 1st to 3rd gear 2 = 1st and 2nd gear 1 = 1st gear Starting only possible in P or N. To move from P, switch on ignition, depress foot brake and press button on selector lever. Press button on selector lever to engage P or R. P: R: Only with vehicle stationary, first apply handbrake Only with vehicle stationary 6 Automatic transmission – see page 182. In brief 21 To select P or R, press button on selector lever. P: Only with vehicle stationary, first apply handbrake R: Only with vehicle stationary 6 Automatic transmission with 3 – see page 188. Picture no: 17330t.tif Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect 3: P = Park R = Reverse gear N = Neutral (idle) D = Automatic gear selection Selector lever in D to left: Manual mode + = Higher gear or stage - = Lower gear or stage P or N must be engaged when starting. To move from P or N, switch on ignition, depress foot brake and press button on selector lever. Picture no: 17004t.tif Exhaust gases are poisonous Exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, which is extremely poisonous but is odourless and colourless. Therefore never inhale exhaust gases, and never run the engine in an enclosed space. Avoid driving with an open luggage compartment. Otherwise, exhaust gases could penetrate the interior. 22 In brief Before starting-off, check: z Tyre pressure and tyre condition – see pages 228, 326. z Engine oil level and fluid levels in engine compartment – see pages 291 to 299. z All windows, mirrors, exterior lighting and number plates are free from dirt, snow and ice and are operational. z No objects are placed in front of the rear window, on the instrument panel or in the area in which the airbags inflate. z Seats, seat belts and mirrors are correctly adjusted. z Brake operation. Picture no: 17005t.tif To start engine: Operate clutch and brake, automatic transmission 3 in P or N, Easytronic 3: depress brake, do not accelerate, petrol engines: Turn key to position 3; diesel engine: Turn key to position 2, when control indicator ! goes out1) turn key to position 3; release key once engine is running Picture no: 17033t.tif Before restarting or switching off the engine, turn key back to 0. To start engine with Open&Start system 3: The electronic key must be inside the vehicle, operate clutch or brake, automatic transmission 3 in P or N, Easytronic 3: depress brake, do not accelerate, petrol engine: Press button; diesel engine: Briefly press button, when control indicator ! goes out1) press button again for 1 second; release button once engine is running To switch on the ignition, only turn the key to 2. Press button again to repeat the starting procedure or switch off the engine. 6 Further information – see pages 67, 243. 1) Preheating system switches on only if outside temperature is low. In brief 23 Warning buzzers Only press briefly to switch in the ignition if the brake or clutch pedal has not been depressed. When starting the engine or whilst driving: z if the electronic key of the Open&Start system is not present or is not recognised 3, Do not start unless vehicle is stationary. 6 Further information – see pages 67, 243. z if a door or the tailgate is ajar, z once you have reached a certain speed if the handbrake is applied 3, z if a specified maximum speed is exceeded 3, Picture no: 17006t.tif Releasing the handbrake: Raise lever slightly, press lock button, lower lever fully To reduce operating forces, depress foot brake at the same time. Drive carefully, economically and with the environment in mind. While driving, do not do anything that could distract you. 6 Brakes - see page 222. z for Easytronic 3 – if A, M or R is selected while the engine is running and the driver’s door is opened but the foot brake is not depressed. When the vehicle is parked and the driver’s door is opened: z when the key is in the starter switch, z with parking lights or dipped beam on, z with Open&Start system 3 and automatic transmission if the selector lever is not in P, z with Easytronic 3 – if the handbrake is not applied and no gear is engaged when the engine is off. 24 In brief Indicator and warning buzzers for Astra TwinTop 3: z Indicator buzzer upon completed opening or closing of the convertible hardtop. z Indicator buzzer upon completed raising or lowering of the electric luggage compartment loading aid. z Gong tone if the boot lid is not closed during roof operation. z Gong tone if the boot lid is not fully opening during operation of the luggage compartment loading aid. z Continuous warning buzzer during roof operation if the anti-roll bars 3 have been triggered. z Continuous warning buzzer starting one minute before the end of the 9-minute standby time with the roof in an intermediate position. z Continuous warning buzzer starting one minute before the end of the 9-minute standby time with the loading aid in a raised position. Picture no: 17007t.tif z Gong tone when vehicle speed exceeds 20 mph (30 km/h) if the roof is not fully open or closed. Parking the vehicle: Apply handbrake firmly, turn engine off, turn ignition off, lock steering wheel, lock vehicle z Three gong tones during roof or loading aid operation if the luggage compartment blind is not attached. To lock, press p button or with Open&Start system 3 touch sensor in one of the front door handles. z Three gong tones during roof operation if outside temperature is below –20 °C, vehicle battery voltage is too low or the system is overloaded. With Open&Start system 3, the driver’s door must be opened to lock the steering wheel. z Gong tone during roof operation if vehicle speed exceeds 20 mph (30 km/h). In brief To activate the anti-theft locking system and the Vauxhall alarm system 3 press button p twice or with Open&Start system 3 touch sensor in one of the front door handles twice. Advice when parking: 6 Further information – see pages 67, 196, Open&Start system – see page 70, radio frequency remote control – see page 68, central locking system – see page 76, Vauxhall alarm system 3 – see page 83, vehicle decommissioning – see page 301, TwinTop roof operation 3 – see page 146. z Always apply the handbrake firmly. Apply the handbrake as firmly as possible on uphill or downhill slopes. To reduce operating forces, depress foot brake at the same time. z Do not park the vehicle on an easy flammable surface. The high temperature of the exhaust system could ignite the surface. z Close the windows and sunroof 3 or TwinTop. z Before switching off ignition: with manual transmission, engage first or reverse gear; with automatic transmission 3, selector lever in P; with Easytronic 3 engage first or reverse gear (note gear indicator – see page 174). z For automatic transmission 3 the key can only be removed when the selector lever is in position P. With the Open&Start system 3 "P" flashes in the transmission display for several seconds if P has not been selected or the handbrake has not been applied. 25 z On vehicles with Easytronic 3 control indicator R flashes for a few seconds after the ignition is switched off if the handbrake has not been applied – see page 179. z With the Open&Start system 3 the engine can only be switched off when the vehicle is stationary. z Remove key. With Open&Start system 3, switch off ignition and open driver’s door. z Turn steering wheel until lock is felt to engage (anti-theft protection). z The engine cooling fans may run after the engine has been switched off – see page 291. 6 Further information – see pages 300, 301. 26 In brief Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories Picture no: 17008t.tif Service work, maintenance We recommend that you entrust all work to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who can provide you with reliable service and correctly perform all work according to factory instructions. 6 If you have a problem – see page 288, service interval display – see pages 44, 290. We recommend that you use "Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories" and conversion parts expressly approved for your vehicle type. These parts have undergone special tests to establish their reliability, safety and specific suitability for Vauxhall vehicles. Despite continuous market monitoring, we cannot assess or guarantee these attributes for other products, even if they have been granted approval by the relevant authorities or in some other form. "Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories" and conversion parts approved by Vauxhall can be obtained from your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who can provide comprehensive advice about permissible technical changes and ensure that the part is installed correctly. 9 Warning Carry out regularly the checks recommended in the individual sections of this Owner’s Manual. Ensure that your vehicle is serviced at the service intervals specified in the Service Booklet. We recommend that you entrust this work to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Have faults remedied without delay! Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. If necessary, interrupt your journey. 6 Maintenance – see page 290. In brief 27 That was the most important information for your first drive in your Astra. The other pages of this chapter contain a summary of the interesting functions in your vehicle. The remaining chapters of the Owner’s Manual contain important information on operation, safety and maintenance as well as a complete index. 28 In brief Picture no: 17009t.tif Vauxhall Full-size airbag system The Vauxhall Full-size airbag system comprises several individual systems. Front airbag system The front airbag system will be triggered in the event of a serious accident involving a frontal impact and forms safety cushions for the driver and front passenger. The forward movement of the driver and front passenger is checked and the risk of injuries to the upper body and head thereby substantially reduced. Picture no: 17010t.tif Picture no: 17011t.tif Side airbag system The side airbag system triggers when a side-on collision occurs and provides a safety barrier for the driver and/or passenger in the respective front door area. This reduces the risk of injury to the upper body considerably in case of a sideimpact. Active head restraints 3 at front seats Curtain airbag system 3 The curtain airbag system triggers in case of a side-on collision and provides a safety barrier in the head area on the respective side of the vehicle. This reduces the risk of injury to the head considerably in case of a side-on collision. Active head restraints are identified by the lettering ACTIVE on the head restraint guide sleeves. 6 Further information – see page 115. In the event of a rear-end impact, the active head restraints automatically tilt forwards. The head is more effectively supported by the head restraint and the risk of injuries caused by whiplash in the neck area is reduced. In brief Picture no: 17012t.tif Picture no: 17013t.tif Operating menus in the information display 3 Selection using multi-function button: rotate and press multi-function button. Menu options are selected using menus and using the buttons or the four-way button or the multi-function button on the Infotainment system 3 or the left-hand adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel. The respective menu options are shown on the display. To exit a menu, turn the multi-function button left or right to Return or Main and select. Selection using four-way button: press four-way button at top, bottom, left or right. Picture no: 17014t.tif 29 Selection using left-hand adjuster wheel on steering wheel: rotate and press adjuster wheel. 30 In brief FM AS [TP] ��� REG CDin MP3 Coolant level 90.6 MHz 19,5° check 19:36 Picture no: 17331t.tif OK Picture no: 17339t.tif Trip computer 3 Check control 3 The trip computers provide information on driving data, which is continually recorded and evaluated electronically. The check control software monitors Functions: z Range z Instantaneous consumption z Distance travelled z Average speed z Effective consumption z Average consumption z Stop watch z Tyre pressure 3 z Fluid levels z Tyre pressure 3 z Radio frequency remote control battery z Vauxhall alarm system 3 z Important exterior lights, including cables and fuses Picture no: 17015t.tif Remote control for Infotainment system 3 The functions of the Infotainment system 3 and the information display can be operated with the buttons on the steering wheel. Further information is available in the Infotainment system operating instructions. In brief Picture no: 17026t.tif Twin Audio 3 Twin Audio provides rear seat occupants the opportunity to listen to a different audio source than the one selected by the driver on the Infotainment system. Only an audio source that is not currently active on the Infotainment system can be controlled using Twin Audio. Two headphone connections are available, with separate volume controls. Further information is available in the Infotainment system operating instructions. Picture no: 17333t.tif Open&Start system with electronic key and radio frequency remote control 3 The Open&Start system allows the vehicle to be locked and unlocked, including antitheft locking system and the Vauxhall alarm system 3 without a mechanical key and the engine to be started and stopped using a Start / Stop button. All the driver has to do is carry the electronic key around with him. 31 Picture no: 17203t.tif Parking distance sensors 3 When reverse gear is selected, the parking distance sensors switch on automatically. The parking distance sensors can also be activated at speeds of less than 15 mph (25 km/h) by pressing the r button on the instrument panel. If the vehicle approaches an obstacle when reversing, a series of signals can be heard in the vehicle interior. The interval between the signals becomes shorter as the distance is reduced. If the distance is less than 30 cm, the signal will be continuous. 32 In brief Picture no: 17961t.tif Sport mode 3 To activate Press SPORT button. SPORT mode is used to change damping 3, steering 3, throttle application and the shift point for Easytronic 3 and automatic transmission 3 while driving. Damping and steering become more direct and provide better contact with the road surface. The engine reacts more quickly to accelerator movements. With Easytronic 3 and automatic transmission 3, the shift times are shortened and shifting takes place at higher revs (not with cruise control enabled 3). Picture no: 17018t.tif Tyre pressure loss monitoring system (DDS = Deflation Detection System) 3 The Deflation Detection System continuously monitors the speed of all wheels while driving. If a tyre loses pressure, it grows smaller and therefore rotates more quickly than the other wheels. If the system detects a difference in speed, the control indicator w illuminates red. Picture no: 17019t.tif After tyre pressure is corrected or a tyre or wheel is changed, the system must be initialised by pressing the DDS button. In brief 33 Ü Board Computer BC 1 BC 2 Timer Tyres Picture no: 17334t.tif Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 The tyre pressure monitoring system continually checks the pressure and speed of all four wheels while driving. A pressure sensor is installed in each wheel. The inflation pressures of the individual wheels are transmitted to a controller, where they are compared. The current tyre pressures can be displayed on the Graphical Information Display or the Colour Information Display 3. Deviating tyre pressures are displayed in the form of messages on the information display whilst driving. Picture no: 17126t.tif Adaptive Forward Lighting (AFL) 3 Improves lighting in curves (curve lighting) on vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlight system. Picture no: Curve lighting The Xenon light beam pivots based on steering wheel position and speed (from approx. 6 mph (10 km/h)). The headlights shine at an angle of up to 15° to the right or left of the direction of travel. Motorway lighting At higher speeds and continuous straight ahead travel, the dipped beam automatically raises slightly, thereby increasing headlight range. 34 In brief Picture no: 17979t.tif Panoramic windscreen 3 To open Turn the handle to the right and move the roof lining rearward to a suitable position. To close Move the roof lining forward to a suitable position. When moved all the way forward, the roof lining engages in position. Picture no: 17059t.tif Picture no: 17092t.tif Adjusting the rear row of seats 3 Cargo box 3 z Pull the handle below the seat Collapsible box to divide the luggage compartment. z Slide the seat bench to the desired position z Release the handle and engage the seat bench The cargo box may only be loaded when the backrests are engaged in an upright position. When removing, start with the right half. In brief Picture no: 17087t.tif FlexOrganizer 3 The side walls contain retaining strips, where various components can be attached to divide the luggage compartment or fasten loads. The system consists of z adapters z variable partition net z mesh pockets for the side walls z hooks in the luggage compartment Picture no: 17980t.tif Luggage compartment cover, Estate To open Push handle on luggage compartment cover down. The cover automatically unrolls. 35 Picture no: 17981t.tif Astra TwinTop With TwinTop, a convertible hardtop, Astra unites the benefits of a coupe with those of a convertible. To optimise safety, the Astra TwinTop is equipped with a rollover protection system with reinforced windscreen frame and the choice of fixed or deployable anti-roll bars in addition to the front and side airbag systems. The roof is operated with the buttons on the roof console above the mirror or with the remote control. To improve luggage compartment accessibility, the electric loading aid makes it possible to raise the open roof when it is stowed in the luggage compartment. 36 Instruments Instruments Picture no: 17020t.tif Control indicators Control indicators ................................ Instrument display ............................... Information display ............................. Radio reception 3................................ Remote control for Infotainment system 3 and information display .. Twin Audio 3 ....................................... Mobile telephones and radio equipment 3...................................... Infotainment system 3........................ 36 45 46 64 The control indicators described here are not present in all vehicles. The descriptions however, apply to all instrument versions. 64 64 Open&Start system 3 If it flashes: System has not detected electronic key in vehicle interior. The reasons for this may be: 65 65 0 Picture no: – The electronic key is in the wrong location in the vehicle interior (do not put key in luggage compartment or in front of information display), or the electronic key is not in the vehicle interior, or influence from an external interference source (radio masts, interfering transmitters in the vicinity). – or – – Electronic key failure, for emergency operation – see page 73. If the battery in the electronic key needs changing, InSP3 appears in the service display or, in vehicles with check control 3, by an appropriate message in the information display – see pages 44, 74. Instruments If it illuminates: Fault in Open&Start system. Lock or unlock vehicle using remote control or emergency key if necessary – see page 80, or attempt to use the spare key. Emergency operation – see page 81. If 0 illuminates, this can also mean that the steering column is still locked: move steering wheel to and fro a little and press Start / Stop button again. If 0 illuminates whilst driving a system error has occurred that may eventually lead to a complete failure. If 0 illuminates or flashes: the Start / Stop button must be held depressed slightly longer to switch off the ignition. It is possible that the vehicle will not start during the next start attempt. If 0 continues to flash or remains illuminated, consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. I Engine oil pressure The control indicator illuminates when the ignition is switched on and goes out shortly after the engine starts. If it illuminates when the engine is running: Engine lubrication may be interrupted. This may result in damage to the engine and/or locking of the drive wheels: 1. Depress clutch. 2. Shift manual transmission or Easytronic 3 into neutral; for automatic transmission 3, set selector lever to N. 3. Move out of the flow of traffic as quickly as possible without impeding other vehicles. 4. Switch off ignition. 37 9 Warning When the engine is off, considerably more force is needed to brake and steer. Do not remove key until vehicle has come to a standstill, otherwise the steering column lock could engage unexpectedly. Check oil level before consulting a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 38 Instruments v Airbag systems 3, belt tensioners, deployable anti-roll bars 3 see pages 112, 121, 130. v Electronic Stability Programme (ESP®Plus) 3 see page 208. X R Picture no: 17020t.tif Brake system, clutch system The control indicator illuminates when the ignition is switched on if the handbrake is applied or if the brake or clutch fluid level is too low. Further information – see pages 222, 296. For vehicles with Easytronic 3, the control indicator flashes for a few seconds when the ignition is turned off if the handbrake is not applied. Picture no: 9 Warning If it illuminates when the handbrake is not applied: stop the vehicle; interrupt your journey immediately. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Seat belt 3 The control indicator illuminates after the ignition is turned on until the seat belt is fastened. When driving begins, the control indicator flashes. Apply seat belt– see page 113. Q Door open Illuminated when a door or the luggage compartment is open. Instruments p Alternator The control indicator illuminates when the ignition is switched on and goes out shortly after the engine starts. If it illuminates when the engine is running: Stop, switch engine off. Battery is not charged. Engine cooling may not be operating. With a diesel engine the brake servo unit may stop operating. Check the drive belt before contacting a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. W Coolant temperature If it illuminates when the engine is running: Stop, switch engine off. Coolant temperature too high: danger of engine damage. Check coolant level immediately – see page 294. A IDS+ Interactive Driving System 3, Continuous Damping Control (CDC) 3, SPORT mode 3 IDS+ – see page 208, CDC – see page 210, SPORT mode – see page 210. If it illuminates when the engine is running: Fault in engine electronics or transmission electronics. Electronics switch to emergency running programme, fuel consumption may increase and driveability of the vehicle may be impaired – see page 206. Consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Engine oil level 3 The engine oil level is checked1) automatically. Engine electronics, Transmission electronics 3, Electronic immobiliser, Diesel fuel filter 3, Fault The control indicator illuminates for a few seconds when the ignition is switched on. Illuminated together with InSP4 in the service display: have the diesel fuel filter drained of water – see page 294. If it flashes when the ignition is on: Fault in the electronic immobiliser system; the engine cannot be started – see page 67. 39 S Illuminated: engine oil level too low. Check engine oil level and top up if necessary – see page 292. 8 Exterior lights The control indicator is illuminated when the exterior lights are on – see page 134. r Parking distance sensors 3, see page 214. 1) Not on Z 14 XEP or Z 20 LEH engine. Sales designation – see page 308. 40 Instruments > Front fog lights 3 The control indicator is illuminated when the front fog lights are on – see page 135. C Main beam The control indicator is illuminated when main beam is on and during headlight flash – see page 15. r O Picture no: 17020t.tif Y Picture no: Turn signal lights The relevant control indicator flashes when the turn signal is on. Rapid flash: failure of a turn signal bulb or the corresponding fuse or failure of a trailer turn signal bulb 3. Both control indicators flash when the hazard warning lights are active. Fuel level If it is illuminated: low fuel level. Fuel gauge in reserve area. Bulb replacement – see page 268. Fuses – see page 261. Petrol engines: erratic fuel supply can cause catalytic converter to overheat – see page 203. If it flashes: fuel supply used up, fill tank immediately. Never let the tank run dry! Diesel engines: if the tank is run dry, bleed the fuel system as described on page 243. Fog tail light The control indicator is illuminated when the fog tail light is on – see page 135. Instruments T Z Winter programme of automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3 Control indicator is illuminated when winter programme is enabled. Exhaust emission 3 The control indicator illuminates when the ignition is switched on and goes out shortly after the engine starts. Further information – see pages 177, 185, 192. 1 If it illuminates when the engine is running: Fault in emission control system. The permitted emission limits may be exceeded. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Further information – see pages 176, 184, 191. If it flashes when the engine is running: Fault that can lead to destruction of the catalytic converter is indicated – see page 205. Consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. SPORT mode of automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3 The control indicator is illuminated when SPORT mode is engaged. y Seat occupancy recognition 3, see page 122. u Anti-lock Brake System (ABS), see page 224. 41 42 Instruments B Adaptive Forward Lighting 3 (AFL), Fault If it is illuminated: System fault. In the event of malfunction of the curve lighting pivot function, the relevant dipped beam light is deactivated. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. AFL – see page 137. m ! Picture no: 17020t.tif Preheating system 3, Diesel particle filter 3 Illuminated during preheating. Preheating system switches on only if outside temperature is low. Flashing (in vehicles with diesel particle filter): diesel particle filter requires cleaning. As soon as the road and traffic situation permits it, increase speed to more than 25 mph (40 km/h) for a brief period. The control indicator goes off as soon as cleaning is complete. w Picture no: Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3, Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 Illuminated red: Tyre pressure loss – see page 217. Illuminated yellow: Fault in system – see pages 217, 218. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Cruise control 3, see page 212. Instruments D Automatic mode of automatic transmission. 1-4 Current gear of automatic transmission. 1-5 or 1-6 3 Manual mode, current gear with Easytronic. For Easytronic 3, the display flashes for a few seconds if A, M or R is selected when the engine is running but the foot brake is not depressed. Picture no: 17022t.tif Transmission display 3 Display of the selected gear position with automatic transmission 3 or the selected gear with Easytronic 3: P Park position of automatic transmission. R Reverse gear. N Neutral or idling position. A Automatic mode of Easytronic. M Manual mode of Easytronic. 43 44 Instruments ESP off Electronic Stability Programme 3 deactivated – see page 208. ESP on Picture no: 17335t.tif. Odometer display Time display 3 To switch between trip odometer and time display 3 give reset knob a short press. Setting the time With time displayed, press reset knob in instrument: Press for approx. 2 seconds: Hours flash Press briefly Set hours Press for approx. 2 seconds Minutes flash Press briefly Set minutes Press for approx. 2 seconds Clock is started Picture no: 17008t.tif Service display InSP Service interval display. Shows remaining distance until next service. Further information – see page 290. InSP2 Bulb failure 3 – see page 268. InSP3 Remote control has low battery voltage 3 – see page 69. InSP4 Water in diesel fuel filter 3. Consult a workshop. On vehicles with check control 3, a message is shown on the display instead of InSP2 and InSP3. Electronic Stability Programme 3 activated – see page 208. Instruments Picture no: 17021t.tif Instrument display On some versions, the pointer of the tachometer, speedometer and fuel gauge briefly moves to its end position when the ignition is switched on. Tachometer Indicates engine speed. Warning zone: maximum permissible engine speed exceeded; danger to engine. Speedometer Indicates the vehicle speed. Picture no: Odometer Records the miles (kilometres) driven. Trip odometer To reset, hold the reset knob depressed for a few seconds with the ignition on. Resetting in vehicles with clock display 3 in odometer: If the clock display is active, first switch to the odometer display. Then briefly press the reset knob – see next page. 45 Picture no: 17023t.tif Fuel gauge Pointer in left zone or Y illuminated Pointer in left zone or Y flashing = Reserve area = Fill up – see page 201 Never run the tank dry! Diesel engines: if the tank is run dry, bleed the fuel system as described on page 243. Because of the fuel remaining in the tank, the amount of fuel required to fill the tank may be less than the specified tank capacity. 46 Instruments 12:01 17 ,0°C FM 3 90,6 MHz REG AS RDS TP 11:25 } 21 .5°C Range Range RDS [TP] 257miles Picture no: 17336t.tif Information display Triple Information Display Display of time, outside temperature and date / Infotainment system (when it is on). When the ignition is off, the time, date and outside temperature can be presented for 15 seconds by briefly pressing one of the two buttons below the display. An F in the display indicates a fault. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17337t.tif Board Information Display 3 Display of time, outside temperature and date / Infotainment system (when it is on). An F in the display indicates a fault. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Inst. consumpt. 19,5° 23° 5 257 miles 7.6 miles/gal Eco x 19:36 Picture no: 17329t.tif Graphical Information Display 3, Colour Information Display 3 Display of time, outside temperature, date / Infotainment system (when it is on) and Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3. The Graphical Information Display presents the information in monochrome. The Colour Information Display presents the information in colour. Instruments The type of information and how it is displayed depends on the equipment of the vehicle and the settings of the trip computer 3, Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 and Infotainment system 3. Some information appears in the display in an abbreviated form. Electronic Climate Control (ECC) – see page 167. : 8:56 -5 ,5°C 07.04.2004 Infotainment system – see Infotainment system instructions. An F in the display indicates a fault. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 47 Slippery road -2,5°C OK Picture no: 17336t.tif Outside temperature A fall in temperature is indicated immediately and a rise in temperature after a time delay. If outside temperature drops to 3 °C, the symbol : illuminates in the Triple Information Display or the Board Information Display 3 as a warning for icy road surfaces. : remains illuminated until temperatures reach at least 5 °C. Picture no: 17338t.tif In vehicles with Graphical Information Display 3 or Colour Information Display 3, a warning message appears the display as a warning for icy road surfaces. There is no message below -5 °C. 9 Warning Caution: the road surface may already be icy even though the display indicates a few degrees above 0 °C. 48 Instruments 8:56 5 ,5°C 07.04.2004 Picture no: 17024t.tif Triple Information Display Setting date and time Infotainment system off: press Ö and ; below the display as follows: Press Ö for approx. 2 seconds: Day flashes ;: Set day Ö: Month flashes ;: Set month Ö: Year flashes ;: Set year Ö: Hours flash ;: Set hours Ö: Minutes flash ;: Set minutes Ö: Clock is started Correcting time 3 Some RDS transmitters do not send a correct time signal. If the incorrect time is continually displayed, switch off automatic time synchronisation 3 and set the time manually - see next column. The automatic setting is indicated by } in the display. Deactivating / activating automatic time synchronisation: Infotainment system off, press Ö and ; below the display: Hold down Ö for approx. 2 sec., clock display is now in setting mode. Press Ö twice (until year flashes). Press Ö and hold down for approx. 3 seconds until } flashes in display 3 and "RDS TIME" appears (years flash during this time). Press ;, display indicates: RDS TIME 0 = Off. Press ;, display indicates: RDS TIME 1 = On. Press Ö three times. Instruments 11:25 } 49 21 .5°C Range 257miles Picture no: 17337t.tif Board Information Display 3, selecting functions Functions and settings of some equipment 3 can be accessed via the Board Information Display. This is done via the menus and the buttons / four-way button on the Infotainment system 3 or with the left adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel. The relevant menu options are then shown on the subsequent row of the display. Picture no: 17012t.tif Select options via the menus and with the buttons / four-way button on the Infotainment system 3. Picture no: 17014t.tif Menu options can also be selected with the left adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel. The relevant menu options are then shown on the subsequent row of the display. If check control 3 issues a warning message, the display is blocked from other functions. Acknowledge the message by pressing the right or left button of the fourway button or by pressing the left adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel. If there are several warning messages, acknowledge them one at a time. System settings – see page 50. Trip computer – see page 52. 50 Instruments The functions are displayed in the following order: 11:25 } 21 .5°C System Picture no: 17337t.tif Board Information Display 3, system settings Press the Settings button of the Infotainment system. Menu item Audio or System will appear. Press the lower button of the four-way button to reach menu item System. After pressing the right-hand part of the fourway button, the first function of the System menu is shown. Some of the functions appear on the display in an abbreviated form. z z z z z z z z z Time synchronisation Time, setting hours Time, setting minutes Date, setting day Date, setting month Date, setting year Ignition logic Language selection Setting units of measure 11:25 } 21 .5°C Clock Sync.On Picture no: 17337t.tif Correcting time 3 Some RDS transmitters do not send a correct time signal. If the incorrect time is continually displayed, deactivate automatic time synchronisation 3 and set the time manually – see next page. Instruments 51 The automatic setting is indicated by } in the display. To correct time with the help of RDS, select the menu item for time synchronisation from the Settings menu. Make the desired setting. Setting date and time Select the menu item for time and date setting from the Settings menu. 11:25 } 21 .5°C English 11:25 } 21 .5°C Unit Europe-SI Make the desired setting. The setting is saved when the menu item is exited. Ignition logic 3 See Infotainment system instructions. Picture no: 17337t.tif Picture no: 17337t.tif Language selection You can select the display language for some functions. Setting units of measure You can select which units of measure are to be used. Select the menu item for language from the Settings menu and make the desired setting. Select the menu item for units of measure from the Settings menu and make the desired setting. 52 Instruments Board Information Display 3, trip computer 3 The trip computer provides information on driving data, which is continually recorded and evaluated electronically. Access trip computer vehicle data by pressing the BC button on the Infotainment system or the left adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel. Some of the functions appear on the display in an abbreviated form. Once an audio function has been selected, the subsequent rows of the trip computer function are displayed. The functions are displayed in the following order: z z z z z z z Instantaneous consumption Average consumption Effective consumption Average speed Distance travelled Range Stop watch 11:25 } 21 .5°C Average consumption Displays average consumption. Calculation can be restarted at any time – see next page. Inst. Consumpt. Effective consumption Displays amount of fuel consumed. Calculation can be restarted at any time – see next page. 7.6 miles/gal Average speed Displays average speed. Calculation can be restarted at any time - see next page. Picture no: 17337t.tif Stoppages in the journey with the ignition off are not included in the calculations. Instantaneous consumption Display changes depending on speed: Display in gal/h below 8 mph (13 km/h). Display in mpg above 8 mph (13 km/h). Distance travelled Displays number of miles (kilometres) driven. Calculation can be restarted at any time – see next page. Instruments 11:25 } 21 .5°C 11:25 } 21 .5°C Range Stop Watch 257miles 01:22:32 h Picture no: 17337t.tif Range Range is calculated from current fuel tank content and instantaneous consumption. The display shows average values. After refuelling, the vehicle updates the range automatically after a brief delay. If the fuel in the tank will allow less than 30 miles (50 km) of travel, the warning "Range" appears on the display. Picture no: 17337t.tif 53 Resetting trip computer information The following trip computer information can be reset (restart of measurement / calculation): z z z z Average consumption Effective consumption Average speed Distance travelled Select the desired trip computer information. Reset by pressing the left adjuster wheel on the steering wheel or the right or left button on the four-way button: Stop watch Operation with the four-way button: Press for more than 2 seconds Current value Press right button Start / Stop Press left button at least 2 seconds Press for more than 4 seconds All values Reset Interruption of power supply If the power supply has been interrupted or if the battery voltage has dropped too low, the values stored in the trip computer will be lost. Operating using the left adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel: Press Start / Stop 54 Instruments Range Inst. consumpt. 19,5° 23° 5 257 miles 7.6 miles/gal Eco x 19:36 Picture no: 17329t.tif Graphical Information Display 3 or Colour Information Display 3, selecting functions The functions and settings of some equipment 3 can be accessed via the Graphical Information Display or the Colour Information Display. Functions are selected and executed in the menu on the display using the four-way button, the multi-function button 3 on the Infotainment system or the left wheel 3 on the steering wheel. Picture no: 17012t.tif Picture no: 17013t.tif To select with four-way button: To select using the multi-function button: Select menu items via menus and with the buttons / four-way button of the Infotainment system. Turn Mark menu items or commands, select functions. If check control 3 issues a warning message, the display is blocked from other functions. Acknowledge the message by pressing the right or left portion of the fourway button. If there are several warning messages, acknowledge them one at a time. Press Select marked item, confirm command. To exit a menu, turn the multi-function button left or right to Return or Main and select. If check control 3 issues a warning message, the display is blocked from other functions. Acknowledge the message by pressing the multi-function button. If there are several warning messages, acknowledge them one at a time. Instruments 7 FM AS [TP] REG CDin MP3 Settings Time, Date 55 19,5° 19:36 19:36 Language ��� 90.6 MHz Units 10 . 07 . 2004 Contrast Day / Night 19,5° Picture no: 17014t.tif To select using the left adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel: Turn up Previous menu item Turn down Next menu item Press Select marked item, confirm command If check control 3 issues a warning message, the display is blocked from other functions. Acknowledge the message by pressing the left adjuster wheel. If there are several warning messages, acknowledge them one at a time. 19:36 Picture no: 17331t.tif For each functional area there is a main page (Main), which is selected at the top edge of the display (not with the Infotainment system CD 30 or the Mobile Phone Portal): z z z z Audio, Navigation 3, Telephone 3, Trip computer 3. For Audio, Navigation 3 and Telephone 3 functions – see Infotainment system instructions. 6 Ign. logic Picture no: 17332t.tif System settings The settings are accessed via the Settings menu. Press the Main button 3 (not found on all Infotainment systems) on the Infotainment system (call up main display). Press the Settings button of the Infotainment system. On Infotainment System CD 30, make sure no menu has been selected. The Settings menu is displayed. 56 Instruments 7 Time, Date 19,5° 19:36 Time 19:36 Date 10 . 07 . 2004 6 Synchron. clock automatical. Picture no: 17340t.tif Setting date and time Select menu item Time, Date from the Settings menu. The menu for Time, Date is displayed. Correcting time 3 In systems with GPS receiver1), date and time are set automatically upon receipt of a GPS satellite signal. If the displayed time does not match local time, it can be corrected manually or automatically by receiving an RDS time signal2) 3. Some RDS transmitters do not send correct time signals. If the incorrect time is displayed often, deactivate automatic time synchronisation 3 and set the time manually. To correct time with the help of RDS, select menu item Synchron. clock automatical. from the Time, Date menu. The box in front of Synchron. clock automatical. will be ticked; see Fig. 17340 T. Select the menu items required: 7 Settings 19,5° 19:36 Time, Date Language Deutsch Units English Contrast Español Day / Night ... 6 Ign. logic Picture no: 17341t.tif Language selection You can select the display language for some functions. Select menu item Language from the Settings menu. The available languages are displayed. Make the desired setting. 1) GPS = Global Positioning System, 2) RDS = Radio Data System. satellite system for world-wide positioning. Instruments 7 13 Languages 19,5° 19:36 X Deutsch 7 Settings 19,5° 19:36 Language ~ Europe-SI Español Units Japan Dutch Contrast | | | French Day / Night Italiano 6 Ign. logic Picture no: 17342t.tif Selections are indicated by a 6 in front of the menu item. In systems with voice output 3, when the language setting of the display is changed the system will ask whether the announcement language should also be changed – see Infotainment system instructions. Contrast 19,5° 19:36 Time, Date English Select the desired language. 7 12 Great Britain USA Picture no: 17343t.tif Setting units of measure You can select which units of measure are to be used. Select menu item Units from the Settings menu. The available units are displayed. Select the desired unit. Selections are indicated by a o in front of the menu item. 57 Picture no: 17926t.tif Adjusting contrast 3 (Graphical Information Display) Select menu item Contrast from the Settings menu. The menu for Contrast is displayed. Confirm the required setting. 58 Instruments Setting display mode 3 The display can be adjusted to suit the light conditions, black or coloured text on a light background or white or coloured text on a dark background. Select menu item Day / Night from the Settings menu. The options are displayed. Automatic: adapted based on vehicle lighting. Always day design: black or coloured text on light background. Always night design: white or coloured text on dark background. Selections are indicated by a o in front of the menu item. Ignition logic 3 See Infotainment system instructions. Ü Board Computer BC 1 BC 2 Timer Tyres 19,5° 19:36 All values 257.0 Ø 40 31.0 Ø 7.0 Range 257 miles miles mph Inst. consumpt. 7.6 miles/gal gal miles/gal Picture no: 17344t.tif Graphical Information Display 3 or Colour Information Display 3, trip computer 3 The trip computers provide information on driving data, which is continually recorded and evaluated electronically. The trip computer main page provides information on range and instantaneous consumption. To display other trip computer data, press the BC button on the Infotainment system 3, select the trip computer menu front the display or press the left adjuster wheel 3 on the steering wheel. 19,5° 23° 5 Eco x 19:36 Picture no: 17329t.tif Range Range is calculated from current fuel tank content and instantaneous consumption. The display shows average values. After refuelling, the vehicle updates the range automatically after a brief delay. Instruments Distance travelled Shows the number of miles (kilometres) travelled. The measurement can be restarted at any time. Ü Board Computer Average speed Calculation of average consumption. The measurement can be restarted at any time. Range BC 1 BC 2 Timer Stoppages in the journey with the ignition off are not included in the calculations. 33miles Tyres Effective consumption Shows the amount of fuel consumed. The measurement can be restarted at any time. OK Picture no: 17345t.tif If the fuel in the tank will allow less than 30 miles (50 km) of travel, the warning "Range" appears on the display. Acknowledge the menu item as described on page 54. Instantaneous consumption Display changes depending on speed: Display in gal/h below 8 mph (13 km/h). Display in mpg above 8 mph (13 km/h). Average consumption Calculation of average consumption. The measurement can be restarted at any time. 59 19,5° 19:36 All values 257.0 Ø 40 Ø 31.0 7.0 miles mph gal miles/gal Picture no: 17344t.tif Resetting trip computer information The following trip computer information can be reset (restart measurements): z z z z distance average speed effective consumption average consumption Select BC 1 or BC 2 from the trip computer menu. 60 Instruments Ü Reset BC 1 19,5° 19:36 257.0 Ø 40 Ø 31.0 7.0 Ü Reset BC 1 19,5° 19:36 All values All values miles mph 257.0 Ø 40 gal miles/gal Picture no: 17346t.tif The information of the two trip computers can be reset separately, making it possible to evaluate data from different time periods. Select the desired trip computer information. The value for the selected function will be reset and recalculated. Ø 31.0 7.0 miles mph gal miles/gal Picture no: 17347t.tif To reset all information of a trip computer, select menu item All values. After resetting, "- - -" is displayed for the trip computer information selected. The recalculated values are displayed after a brief delay. Interruption of power supply If the power supply has been interrupted or if the battery voltage has dropped too low, the values stored in the trip computer will be lost. Instruments 61 The desired stop watch display can be selected from the Options menu 3: Ü Board Computer 19,5° 19:36 BC 1 00:00:00 BC 2 Timer Tyres Start Reset Options Picture no: 17348t.tif Stop watch Driving Time excl. Stops The time the vehicle is in motion is recorded. Stationary time is not included. Driving Time incl. Stops The time the vehicle is in motion is recorded. The time the vehicle is stationary with the key in the starter switch is included. Travel Time Measurement of the time from manual activation via Start to manual deactivation via Reset. Ü Board Computer BC 1 BC 2 Timer Tyres Picture no: 17334t.tif Display of current tyre pressure 3 Select menu item Timer from the Board Computer menu. Select menu item Tyres from the Board Computer menu. The Timer menu is displayed. The current pressure of each tyre is displayed. To start, select menu item Start. To reset, select menu item Reset. Further information – see page 218. 62 Instruments Check control 3 Check control monitors several fluid levels, tyre pressure 3, the radio frequency remote control batteries, Vauxhall alarm system 3, and important external lights, including cables and fuses. When towing, trailer lighting is also monitored. Warning messages appear on the display. If there are several warning messages, they are displayed one after the other. Some of the warning messages appear on the display in an abbreviated form. Examples of warning messages for the Graphical Information Display 3 and Colour Information Display 3 are depicted. On the Board Information Display, messages appear in an abbreviated form. Acknowledge warning messages as described on pages 49, 54. Unacknowledged warning messages can be re-displayed later. Coolant level check Warning messages: Remote Control Battery check Battery voltage of remote control or electronic key of Open&Start system too low – see page 69. OK Picture no: 17339t.tif Brakelight switch check Fault. Brake light does not come on when brake applied. Have cause of fault remedied immediately. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Safeguard check Fault. System error in Vauxhall alarm system. Have cause of fault remedied immediately. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Instruments If there is a fault in the lighting system, the respective location of the fault is displayed as text, e.g.: Brakelight check right In vehicles with tyre pressure monitoring system 3, if tyre pressure is too low, the display indicates which tyre to check, e.g.: Tyre pressure check rear right tyre (value in psi / bar) Check tyre pressure at next opportunity using suitable gauge. Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 – see page 218. Checking tyre pressure – see page 326. In vehicles with tyre pressure control system 3, if there is major loss of pressure in a tyre, the display indicates the tyre at fault, e.g.: Attention! Rear left tyre pressure loss (value in psi / bar) Stop immediately and check tyre. Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 – see page 218. 63 Wash fluid level check Fluid level in windscreen wash system too low. Topping up wash fluid – see page 299. Rear window wash system and headlight wash system 3 are deactivated if wash fluid level is low. Coolant level check Fluid level in engine cooling system is low. Check coolant level immediately – see page 294. Interruption of power supply Stored warning messages appear on the display one after the other. 64 Instruments Radio reception 3 Car radio reception differs from domestic radio reception: As the vehicle antenna is relatively near the ground, the broadcasting companies cannot guarantee the same quality of reception as obtained with a domestic radio using an overhead antenna. z Changes in distance from the transmitter, z multi-path reception due to reflection and z shadowing may cause hissing, noise, distortion or loss of reception altogether. Picture no: 17015t.tif Remote control for Infotainment system 3 and information display The functions of the Infotainment system 3 and the information display can be operated with the buttons on the steering wheel. Further information – see page 49 and the relevant operating instructions. Picture no: 17026t.tif Twin Audio 3 Twin Audio provides rear seat occupants the opportunity to listen to a different audio source than the one selected by the driver on the Infotainment system. Only an audio source that is not currently active on the Infotainment system can be controlled using Twin Audio. Two headphone connections are available, with separate volume controls. Further information is available in the Infotainment system operating instructions. Instruments Mobile telephones and radio equipment 3 The Vauxhall installation instructions and the operating guidelines provided by the telephone manufacturer must be observed when fitting and operating a mobile telephone. Failure to do so could invalidate the vehicle’s operating permit (EU Directive 95/54/EG). Prerequisites for fault-free operation: z professionally installed exterior antenna to obtain the maximum range possible, z maximum transmission power 10 Watt, z installation of the telephone in a suitable spot (see information on page 124). Obtain advice on predetermined installation locations for the external antenna and equipment holder and ways of using devices with transmission power of more than 10 Watts. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will have brackets and various installation kits available as accessories and will install them in accordance with regulations. 65 For reasons of safety, we recommend that you do not use the phone while driving. Even use of a hands-free set can be a distraction while driving. Be sure to observe any country-specific regulations. 9 Warning When used in the vehicle interior, mobile telephones and radio equipment (CB) with integrated antenna may cause malfunctions in the vehicle electronics. Mobile telephones and radio equipment (CB) should only be used with an antenna fitted on the vehicle exterior. Infotainment system 3 The Infotainment system is operated as described in the operating instructions. 66 Keys, doors, bonnet Keys, doors, bonnet Replacement keys The key is a constituent of the electronic immobiliser. Ordering keys from a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer guarantees problemfree operation of the electronic immobiliser. When electronic keys of the Open&Start system are being replaced, all keys must be handed to the dealer for programming. Keep the spare key in a safe spot. Electronic immobiliser.......................... Radio frequency remote control 3 with mechanical key ......................... Open&Start system 3 .......................... Central locking system ........................ Fault when locking or unlocking......... Luggage compartment....................... Vauxhall alarm system 3.................... Child safety locks................................. Bonnet .................................................. 67 68 70 76 80 81 83 86 86 Locks – see page 305, Open&Start system, electronic keys – see page 70. Lock cylinders Designed to free-wheel if they are forcefully rotated without the correct key or if the correct key is not fully inserted. To reset, turn cylinder with the correct key until its slot is vertical, remove key and then re-insert it. If the cylinder still free-wheels, turn the key through 180° and repeat operation. Car Pass The Car Pass contains all of the vehicle’s data and should therefore not be kept in the vehicle. Have your Car Pass to hand when consulting a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17027t.tif Key with foldaway key section 3 Press button to extend. Press button to retract; key section engages audibly. Keys, doors, bonnet Picture no: 17349t.tif Electronic immobiliser The system checks whether the vehicle may be started with the mechanical key or electronic key of the Open&Start system 3 that is being used. If the key is recognised as "authorised" the vehicle can be started. The check takes place via a transponder in the key. The electronic immobiliser activates itself automatically after the key has been removed from the ignition or, with the Open&Start system 3, when the engine is switched off by pressing the Start / Stop button. Picture no: 17033t.tif Control indicator for electronic immobiliser Control indicator A illuminates briefly when the ignition is switched on. If the control indicator flashes when the ignition is on, there is a fault in the system; the engine cannot be started. Switch off the ignition and then repeat the start attempt. If control indicator A continues to flash, try to start the engine using the spare key and consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 67 Picture no: 17028t.tif If control indicator A illuminates after the engine is started, there is a fault in the engine electronics or transmission electronics 3 (see pages 180, 186, 194, 206) or there is water in the diesel fuel filter 3 (see page 294). Note The electronic immobiliser does not lock the doors. Therefore, after leaving the vehicle always lock it and switch on the Vauxhall alarm system 3 – see pages 76, 83. 68 Keys, doors, bonnet Store and activate personal vehicle settings using the remote control The climate control and instrument illumination settings are automatically stored specifically for the vehicle key used. Different settings are stored for each remote control. Use of a remote control will activate the settings associated with it. Central locking system, mechanical anti-theft locking system, see page 76. Picture no: 17029t.tif Radio frequency remote control 3 with mechanical key Radio frequency remote control in version with Open&Start system – see page 70. The remote control is integrated in the key. Used to operate: z central locking system, z mechanical anti-theft locking system, z Vauxhall alarm system 3. The windows of vehicles with electrically operated windows in all doors 3 can also be opened or closed from outside using the remote control - see page 79. On the Astra TwinTop, the roof can also be opened or closed with the remote control. Picture no: 17030t.tif The radio frequency remote control has a range of approx. 3 metres. This range can be affected by outside influences. Aim the remote control at the vehicle to operate. Handle the remote control with care, protect it from moisture and high temperatures and avoid unnecessary operation. The hazard warning lights come on to indicate that the remote control is operational. Vauxhall alarm system 3, see page 83. Electrically operated door windows 3, see page 141. Astra TwinTop, see page 146. Keys, doors, bonnet Fault If the central locking system cannot be operated with the radio frequency remote control, it may be due to the following: Make sure that you dispose of old batteries in accordance with environmental protection regulations. Key with fixed key section Entrust battery replacement to a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. z The range of the remote control has been exceeded. z Remote control battery voltage is too low. Battery replacement – see next column. z Frequent, repeated operation of the remote control outside the reception range of the vehicle (e.g. too far from vehicle, remote control is then no longer recognised). Remote control synchronisation - see right-hand column. z If the central locking system is overloaded as a result of repeated operation at short intervals. The power supply is cut off for a brief period. z Interference from higher-power radio waves from other sources. To eliminate the cause of the fault, contact your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Open driver’s door with key – see next pages. 69 Radio frequency remote control synchronisation After changing the battery, unlock the door with the key in the lock see next page. Picture no: 17031t.tif Remote control battery replacement Key with foldaway key section Replace the battery as soon as the range of the remote control begins to shrink. Extending the key – see page 66. Open the remote control. Replace the battery (battery type – see page 335), noting installation position. Close the remote control. Inserting the key in the ignition lock synchronises the remote control. 70 Keys, doors, bonnet Picture no: 17333t.tif Open&Start system 3 The Open&Start system allows the vehicle to be locked and unlocked, (including the anti-theft locking system and the Vauxhall alarm system 3), and the engine to be started and stopped without a mechanical key. All the driver has to do is keep the key on his person. The windows of vehicles with electrically operated windows in all doors 3 can also be opened or closed from outside using the remote control of the electronic key see page 79. On the Astra TwinTop, the roof can also be opened or closed with the remote control of the electronic key. Picture no: 17032t.tif The electronic key must be within the external reception range about 1 metre from the vehicle in order to lock and unlock the vehicle. If the electronic key is recognized as "authorised", the vehicle can be unlocked by pulling a door handle or the button beneath the tailgate handle and the doors and the tailgate can be opened. Picture no: 17033t.tif When the Start / Stop button is pressed, the system re-checks the authorisation. The electronic key has to be recognised in the interior in order to do this. After the key has been authorised, the ignition switches on. At the same time, the electronic immobiliser is switched off and the electro-mechanical steering column lock is released. Pressing the Start / Stop button again with the brake or clutch pedal depressed or in P or N with automatic transmission 3 starts the engine. Press the button for at least one second with the vehicle stationary or hold until the engine starts. Keys, doors, bonnet 71 If the brake or clutch pedal is depressed, the engine can be started right away with a single press on the Start / Stop button. Releasing the Start / Stop button interrupts the starting procedure. The engine and the ignition are switched off by pressing the Start / Stop button again. The vehicle must be stationary. The immobiliser is activated at the same time. If the ignition has been switched off and the vehicle is stationary, the steering column lock activates automatically when the driver’s door is opened or closed. The electronic key must be within the interior reception in order to switch the ignition on or off. We recommend that the driver carries the electronic key on his or her person. If the electronic key is not recognised, try a different position for the key. Do not put the electronic key in the luggage compartment or in front of the information display. Picture no: 17034t.tif The vehicle is locked from the outside with the doors closed by touching the sensor panel in the door handle of one of the front doors. The electronic key must be within the external reception range of approximately one metre from the vehicle. The Open&Start system 3 does not the lock the vehicle automatically if the electronic key is outside the external reception range of approximately one metre from the vehicle. Picture no: 17035t.tif Radio frequency remote control The vehicle can be locked and unlocked by conventional means using the remote control with the buttons on the electronic key. In addition, the anti-theft locking system and Vauxhall alarm system can be armed and disabled using the remote control. The windows of vehicles with electrically operated windows in all doors 3 can also be opened or closed from outside using the remote control. 6 72 Keys, doors, bonnet The remote control has a range of approx. 3 metres. This range can be affected by outside influences. Aim the remote control at the vehicle to operate. If the control indicator 0 is permanently on, an error has occurred in the system. Lock or unlock vehicle using the radio frequency remote control or the emergency key if necessary – see page 80, or try using the spare key. Handle the remote control with care, protect it from moisture and high temperatures and avoid unnecessary operation. If 0 illuminates, this can also mean that the steering column is still locked: move steering wheel to and fro a little and press Start / Stop button again. The hazard warning lights come on to indicate that the remote control is operational. Storing and retrieving personal vehicle settings with the electronic key The climate control and instrument illumination settings are automatically stored specifically for the vehicle key used. Different settings are stored for each electronic key. Use of an electronic key will activate the settings associated with it. Central locking system, mechanical anti-theft locking system, see page 76. Vauxhall alarm system 3, see page 83. Electrically operated door windows 3, see page 141. Astra TwinTop, see page 146. Picture no: 17036t.tif Control indicator for Open&Start system 0 If the control indicator 0 flashes with the ignition switched on or with the engine running an operating error has occurred, e.g. the electronic key is no longer within the reception range of the vehicle interior. During the next starting procedure the engine may not be able to be started. Press Start / Stop key slightly longer to switch the ignition off. Flashing of 0 can also be an indication of complete failure of the electronic key. In this case operation is only possible using the emergency facility – see page 73. InSP3 in the service display or an appropriate message in the information 3 display indicates that the battery of the electronic key needs replacing – see page 74. Illumination of 0 whilst driving indicates a system fault. Consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Emergency operation – see page 73. Lockable glove compartment, Astra TwinTop with Open&Start system 3 In addition to the electronic key of the Open&Start system, there is a standard key without remote control for the glove compartment lock. Keys, doors, bonnet Picture no: 17037t.tif Emergency operation If the Open&Start system or the electronic key fails (control indicator 0 flashes or is permanently on) the driver’s door can be locked or unlocked with the emergency key in the electronic key: press locking mechanism on underside and remove cap toward the front by applying gentle pressure to the cap. Push emergency key towards the outside over the detent and remove. Picture no: 17038t.tif Only the driver’s door can be locked and unlocked using the emergency key. Unlock the entire vehicle as described on page 80. In model variants with Vauxhall alarm system 3, the alarm may be triggered when the vehicle is unlocked. Switch ignition on to deactivate alarm and release the steering column lock: hold electronic key at marked position (see Fig. 17039T in next column) on the steering column panelling and press the Start / Stop button. Repeat procedure if necessary. 73 Picture no: 17039t.tif To start the engine, hold the electronic key at the marked position, depress brake pedal or clutch pedal or in vehicles with automatic transmission 3 depress brake pedal and engage P or N, then press the Start / Stop button. Press Start / Stop button for at least 1 second to switch the engine off. Lock all doors except driver’s door as described on page 80. Unlock driver’s door with emergency key. This facility is only intended for emergencies. Replace battery in electronic key at the earliest opportunity or have the system repaired. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 74 Keys, doors, bonnet Radio frequency remote control synchronisation The remote control synchronises itself automatically during every starting procedure. Picture no: 17040t.tif Replacing battery in electronic key Replace the battery immediately if the system is no longer working properly or the range of the radio frequency remote control is reducing. The need for a battery change is indicated via InSP3 in the service display or, in vehicles with check control 3, by an appropriate message in the display see page 44. Picture no: 17041t.tif To replace the battery, press the locking mechanism on the underside of the electronic key and remove the cover towards the front by applying gentle pressure - see page 73, Fig. 17037 T. Push off cover with emblem on the button side towards the outside. Replace battery, for battery type – see page 335, pay attention to installation position. Engage caps. Keys, doors, bonnet Fault in Open&Start system or radio frequency remote control If the central locking cannot be operated or the engine cannot be started, the cause may be one of the following: z Electronic key out of reception range, or out of range of remote control. z Remote control battery voltage too low – see previous page for instructions on how to change battery. z Frequent, repeated operation of the remote control outside the reception range (e.g. too far from vehicle, remote control is then no longer recognised). z If the central locking system is overloaded as a result of repeated operation at short intervals. The power supply is cut off for a brief period. z Interference from higher-power radio waves from other sources. To remedy the cause of the problem, move electronic key or remote control to another location or change the remote control battery. If the problem persists we recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Emergency operation – see page 73. 75 76 Keys, doors, bonnet Securing with mechanical anti-theft locking system 9 Warning Do not use the system if there are people in the vehicle! The doors cannot be unlocked from inside. Picture no: 17042t.tif Central locking system For doors, boot lid / tailgate and tank flap. To lock Radio frequency remote control with mechanical key Press button p on remote control. Picture no: 17034t.tif Open&Start system with electronic key 3 The electronic key must be outside of the vehicle. There must not be any electronic key in the vehicle interior. All of the doors and the luggage compartment are locked by touching the sensor in the handle of the driver’s or front passenger’s door – or – by pressing button p of the electronic key’s remote control. Keys, doors, bonnet 77 Press button p of the electronic key’s remote control again. If the ignition was on, the driver’s door must be opened and closed once so that the vehicle can be secured. Lock buttons on all doors are positioned such that doors cannot be opened. Picture no: 17043t.tif Radio frequency remote control with mechanical key All doors must be closed. At the latest 15 seconds after locking, press button p of the remote control again. Lock buttons on all doors are positioned such that doors cannot be opened. If the ignition was on, the driver’s door must be opened and closed once so that the vehicle can be secured. Picture no: 17044t.tif Open&Start system with electronic key 3 All doors must be closed. The electronic key must be outside of the vehicle. No more than 15 seconds after locking, touch the sensor in the handle of the driver’s or front passenger’s door again – or – 78 Keys, doors, bonnet Picture no: 16968t.tif To unlock Remote control with mechanical key Press button q on remote control. Picture no: 17032t.tif Open&Start system with electronic key 3 The electronic key must be outside of the vehicle. The vehicle is unlocked by pulling a door handle or operating the button beneath the tailgate handle – or – by pressing button q of the electronic key’s remote control. Picture no: 17045t.tif Central locking switch for locking and unlocking the doors from inside the vehicle Press button m in the centre console: doors are locked or unlocked. If the key is in the ignition, locking is only possible if all doors are closed. When the mechanical anti-theft locking system is active – see previous page – the doors cannot be unlocked with this button. Keys, doors, bonnet Note z If the driver’s door is not closed properly, the central locking system will not lock. z The LED in the central locking switch m comes on for around 2 minutes after locking. z To lock the doors from within (e.g. to prevent unwanted entry from outside), press central locking switch m in the centre console. z With the Open&Start system 3 the vehicle cannot be unlocked until 2 seconds after locking. Within this time, a door handle can be pulled or the button beneath the tailgate handle operated to check whether the vehicle is locked. z After unlocking with the key in the lock and opening the driver’s door, the entire vehicle is unlocked. z If locked via the central locking system, the doors can also be opened by pulling the inside door handles. The central locking system is also unlocked at this time (not possible on Astra TwinTop when the roof is open). z Locked doors unlock automatically in the event of an accident of a certain severity (to allow external help to gain access). The hazard warning lights and courtesy light also come on. For this to occur, the key must be in the starter switch. z The Open&Start system 3 does not lock the vehicle automatically if the electronic key is outside the reception range of the vehicle (more than 1 metre away from the vehicle). z When using the Open&Start system 3, there must not be an electronic key inside the vehicle when locking. z The locking sensors in the door handles must be kept clean to ensure unrestricted functionality of the Open&Start system 3. 79 Picture no: 17046t.tif Operating the windows 3 from the outside 9 Warning Take care when operating the electrically operated door windows. Risk of injury, particularly to children. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. Keep a close watch on the windows when closing them. Ensure that nothing becomes trapped in them as they move. The windows of vehicles with electrically operated windows in all doors 3 can also be opened or closed from outside: 6 80 Keys, doors, bonnet Overload The power supply is cut off for a brief period if the central locking system is repeatedly operated at short intervals. The system is protected by a fuse in the fusebox – see page 261. Further information on windows with electric drive – see page 143. Picture no: 17034t.tif Radio frequency remote control with mechanical key Hold button q or p on the remote control depressed until all windows have opened or completely closed. Open&Start system with electronic key 3 Hold down button q of remote control to open. To close, hold down button p or touch sensor in door handle for longer. The electronic key must be recognised within the external reception range. It is advisable for the driver to keep the electronic key on his person. Further information on windows – see page 141. Picture no: 17047t.tif Fault when locking or unlocking Fault in radio frequency remote control or Open&Start system To unlock Turn key or emergency key for Open&Start system (see page 73) towards front of vehicle in the driver’s door lock as far as it will go. Return key to a vertical position and remove. The entire vehicle is unlocked when the driver’s door is opened. Keys, doors, bonnet Luggage compartment For Astra TwinTop with open roof - after opening the driver’s door, press the central locking switch m in the centre console. The vehicle will then be unlocked, provided the anti-theft locking system is not engaged. Switch on the ignition to deactivate the Vauxhall alarm system 3. Emergency operation of the Open&Start system – see page 73. To lock Open passenger’s door, close driver’s door, press central locking switch m in centre console. Central locking system locks all doors. Close passenger’s door. Malfunction in central locking system To unlock Turn key or emergency key with Open&Start system – see page 73, towards front of vehicle in the driver’s door lock as far as it will go. Turn key back to a vertical position and remove. The other doors can be opened by pulling the handle on the inside of the doors (not possible if anti-theft locking system enabled beforehand). The luggage compartment and the fuel filler cap remain locked. To deactivate the anti-theft locking system, switch ignition on – see page 14. 81 To unlock Radio frequency remote control with mechanical key Press button q of remote control, the luggage compartment is unlocked together with the doors and can be opened by pulling the button beneath the handle. Picture no: 17048t.tif To lock Insert the key or emergency key for Open&Start system (see page 73) into the opening above the lock on the inside of the door and press until the lock audibly engages. Then close the door. The procedure must be repeated for each door. The driver’s door can also be locked from outside using the lock. The unlocked fuel filler flap and tailgate / boot lid cannot be locked. Emergency operation of Open&Start system 3, see page 73. Open&Start system with electronic key 3 The luggage compartment and the doors can be unlocked and opened by operating the button beneath the handle if the electronic key is recognised outside of the vehicle – or – by pressing button q of the electronic key’s remote control. 82 Keys, doors, bonnet Picture no: 16969t.tif To open The luggage compartment is opened by operating the button beneath the handle. Open luggage compartment 9 Warning Do not drive with the tailgate open or ajar, e.g. when transporting bulky objects, since toxic exhaust gas could penetrate the interior. Fitting of accessories on the tailgate will increase its weight. If it becomes too heavy, the tailgate will then not stay open. Picture no: 17049t.tif Picture no: 17029t.tif To close There is a handle on the inside of the tailgate for closing the luggage compartment. To lock Radio frequency remote control with mechanical key Press button p on remote control. Do not operate the button beneath the handle when closing. Otherwise the luggage compartment will once again be unlocked. Open&Start system with electronic key 3 Press button p of the electronic key remote control or touch sensor in handle of one of the front doors. The electronic key must be recognised in the external reception area. It is advisable for the driver to keep the electronic key on his person. Keys, doors, bonnet 83 Vauxhall alarm system 3 monitors z the doors, luggage compartment, bonnet, z the passenger’s compartment, z vehicle tilt, e.g. if it is raised, z the ignition. 9 Warning Do not use the system if there are people in the vehicle! The doors cannot be unlocked from the inside. Picture no: 17043t.tif To activate Remote control with mechanical key All doors, windows, the sunroof 3 and the bonnet must be closed. Within 15 seconds of locking, press button p on the remote control again. If the ignition was switched on, the driver’s door must be opened and closed so that the Vauxhall alarm system can be switched on. Picture no: 17044t.tif Open&Start system with electronic key 3 The doors, the windows and the bonnet must be closed. The electronic key must be outside of the vehicle. Touch the sensor in the door handle of the driver’s or front passenger’s door again no more than 15 seconds after locking – or – press button p of the electronic key’s remote control again. If the ignition was switched on, the driver’s door must be opened and closed once so that the Vauxhall alarm system can be switched on. 84 Keys, doors, bonnet 4. Switch on Vauxhall alarm system. LED illuminates. After approx. 10 seconds the system is activated, without monitoring of the passenger’s compartment or vehicle tilt. LED flashes until system is switched off. For Astra TwinTop, passenger’s compartment monitoring is deactivated if the roof is open to prevent false alarms. Light emitting diode (LED) During the first 10 seconds of Vauxhall alarm system activation: Picture no: 17050t.tif Activation without monitoring of passenger’s compartment and vehicle tilt e.g. if animals are to be left in the vehicle. 1. Close tailgate and bonnet. 2. Press button b in the roof console. The LED in button m flashes (max. 10 seconds) – see next column. 3. Close doors. z LED illuminated z LED flashes rapidly = = Test, switch-on delay Door, luggage compartment, bonnet open, system fault Picture no: 17051t.tif After the first 10 seconds of Vauxhall alarm system activation: z LED flashes slow z LED illuminates for approx. 1 second = System switched on = Switch-off If a system fault occurs, consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Keys, doors, bonnet 85 Note Changes to the vehicle interior, such as the use of seat covers, could impair the function of the passenger’s compartment monitoring. Alarm While the Vauxhall alarm system is switched on the alarm can be triggered: z an acoustic signal (horn) and z a visual signal (hazard warning lights). The number and duration of the alarms are legally established. Picture no: 16968t.tif To deactivate Remote control with mechanical key Press button q on the remote control – or – switch on the ignition. Picture no: 17032t.tif Open&Start system with electronic key 3 Pulling a handle or operating the button beneath the tailgate handle unlocks the vehicle and disarms the Vauxhall alarm system if the electronic key has been recognised outside of the vehicle – or – if button q on the electronic key’s remote control has been pressed. In the event of a fault in the radio frequency remote control or the Open&Start system, open the vehicle as described on page 80. If the alarm is triggered when the driver’s door is opened, deactivate the Vauxhall alarm system by switching on the ignition. The alarm is silenced by pressing a button of the remote control or by switching on the ignition. The Vauxhall alarm system is deactivated at the same time. Alarm siren with integrated battery 3 The alarm siren monitors the on-board voltage network and triggers an alarm if this network is manipulated (e.g. if the vehicle’s battery is disconnected by unauthorised persons). The alarm siren has its own power supply and is therefore not dependent on the vehicle’s battery. If the vehicle’s battery is to be disconnected (e.g. for maintenance work), the alarm siren must be deactivated as follows: switch the ignition on then off, disconnect the vehicle’s battery within 15 seconds. To switch off alarm siren: Switch ignition on then off. 86 Keys, doors, bonnet Picture no: 17052t.tif Child safety locks 9 Warning Use the child safety lock whenever children are occupying the rear seats. Disregard may lead to injuries or endanger life. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. Using key or screwdriver, turn knob on rear door lock from the vertical position: door cannot be opened from inside. Bonnet Picture no: 17053t.tif To open the bonnet, pull the release lever located on the driver’s side below the instrument panel. The bonnet will then be unlocked and will partially open. Return release lever to its original position. There is a safety catch on the underside of the bonnet: lift this upwards and open the bonnet. When the bonnet is opened, snow or dirt on the bonnet can slide down and obstruct the air intake. Air intake – see page 173. Picture no: 17054t.tif The bonnet is held open automatically 3. On other model variants, hold the bonnet open by engaging the support that runs across the radiator in the small slot on the underside of the bonnet. Press the support firmly into place in its retainer before closing the bonnet. Lower the bonnet and allow it to drop into its catch. Check that the bonnet is locked in position by pulling at its front edge. If it is not engaged, repeat the procedure. Seats, Interior Seats, Interior Head restraints .................................... Armrest 3 by driver’s seat .................. Adjusting the rear row of seats 3 ...... Armrest 3 in the rear backrest ........... Luggage compartment enlargement, Hatchback ......................................... Luggage compartment enlargement, Estate without adjustable rear row of seats .............................................. Luggage compartment enlargement, Estate with adjustable rear row of seats ................................................... Extending the luggage compartment, Astra TwinTop ................................... Folding down the front passenger’s seat 3................................................. Luggage compartment cover ............ Safety net 3, Estate............................. Rails and hooks in the luggage compartment 3, Estate .................... FlexOrganizer 3, Estate ...................... Lashing eyes 3 .................................... Cargo box 3......................................... Luggage compartment blind, Astra TwinTop ................................... Easy Load............................................. Notes on loading the vehicle.............. Cigarette lighter 3............................... Accessory socket 3.............................. Ashtray 3 ............................................. Foldaway tables 3 .............................. Stowage compartments...................... Sunvisors............................................... 87 Push front passenger’s seat as far back as possible. 88 89 90 90 The seat backrests must not be tilted too far back (recommended maximum tilting angle approx. 25°). 9 Warning 91 Do not sit nearer than 10 inches (25 cm) from the steering wheel, to permit safe airbag deployment. 92 94 96 97 97 99 100 101 102 102 102 103 104 105 106 106 107 108 108 Picture no: 17350t.tif Front seat adjustment see pages 3, 4. Seating position Adjust driver’s seat such that with the driver sitting upright the steering wheel is held in the area of its upper spokes with the driver’s arms slightly bent. Failure to observe the descriptions could lead to injuries which could be fatal. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly before starting-off. 88 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17055t.tif Head restraints The middle of the head restraint should be at eye level. If this is not possible for extremely tall persons, set to highest position, and set to lowest position for small persons. 9 Warning Failure to observe the descriptions can lead to injuries which could be fatal. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly before moving away. 6 Removal - see page 89. Picture no: 16976t.tif To adjust front seat head restraints (all model variants) and outboard rear head restraints, Hatchback and Estate To adjust, press button on side and adjust height. To fold down the backrests (see page 91) or improve visibility when the rear seats are not occupied, remove the head restraints or push them all the way down. If seats are occupied, pull head restraints upwards. Picture no: 18019t.tif To adjust the centre rear head restraint 3, Hatchback and Estate To adjust, pull the head restraint up or press the catch to release. Then push the head restraint down. To fold down the backrest (see page 91) or improve visibility when the centre rear seat is not occupied, remove the head restraint or push it all the way down. If seat is occupied, pull head restraint upwards. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17983t.tif To adjust the rear head restraints 3, Astra TwinTop To adjust, pull the head restraint up or press the two catches to release. Then push the head restraint down. To improve visibility when the rear seats are not occupied, push the head restraints all the way down. If seats are occupied, pull head restraints upwards. Do not place any objects on the cover behind the head restraints or between the head restraints and the anti-roll bars 3. Picture no: 17056t.tif Picture no: 17058t.tif Removing the head restraints Press and release the two catches. Pull and remove the head restraint. Armrest 3 by driver’s seat To fold down the backrests 3 (see page 91), push the rear head restraints all the way down or remove. The armrest can be moved to different positions in stages by lifting it. Push raised armrest backward against resistance and fold down. 89 90 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17059t.tif Picture no: 17060t.tif Adjusting the rear row of seats 3 Armrest 3 in the rear backrest Pull the handle below the seat the slide the seat bench to the desired position. Fold down the armrest, pulling the strap obliquely down (45°). Release the handle and engage the seat bench. When the centre rear seat is in use or the rear backrests are folded, fold the armrest up. A flap located behind the armrest facilitates transport of long, narrow objects – see page 95. Picture no: 17982t.tif Astra TwinTop Pull the armrest by the strap, pivot it down and position on the seat with the flat side up. The armrest is held in place on the backrest with a retaining strap. To fully remove the armrest, disengage the bracket at the retaining strap. A flap located behind the armrest facilitates transport of long, narrow objects – see page 96. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17061t.tif Luggage compartment enlargement, Hatchback Folding the backrest Pushing rear head restraints all the way down or remove – see page 88. Slide front seat forward slightly. Disengage the backrest (single or split 3) using the pushbutton and fold it down onto the seat cushion. Return front seat to desired position. Picture no: 17062t.tif 91 Picture no: 17063t.tif Fold down centre backrest 3 Push head restraint all the way down – see page 88. Restoring backrest to an upright position Guide the seat belt through the side bracket to protect against damage. Disengage backrest using handle and fold onto seat cushion. Restore the backrest to an upright position and audibly engage. Folding down the centre seat backrest makes it possible to load longer objects. The outer seats can still be used for occupants. The three-point seat belt for the centre rear seat can only be pulled from its inertia reel if the backrest is properly engaged. 9 Warning The load must not hinder handbrake operation or gearshifting. Notes on loading see page 104. 92 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17064t.tif Luggage compartment enlargement, Estate without adjustable rear row of seats Fold the backrest onto the seat cushion Push the rear head restraints all the way down or remove – see page 88. Detach the hooks of the luggage compartment cover from the head restraints – see page 98. Slide front seat forward slightly. Disengage the backrest (single or split) using the pushbutton and fold it down onto the seat cushion. Return front seat to desired position. Picture no: 17065t.tif Raise the seat cushion and fold the backrest Pull the strap on the seat cushion and lift the backrest forwards (single or split). Detach the hooks of the luggage compartment cover from the head restraints – see page 98. Picture no: 17066t.tif Remove the outer rear head restraints. Push the centre head restraint all the way down – see page 88. Stow the removed head restraints in the cavity below the raised seat cushions. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17067t.tif Disengage the backrest (single or split) using the pushbutton, fold it forward and engage. Picture no: 17062t.tif Fold down centre backrest 3 Push head restraint all the way down – see page 88. Disengage backrest using handle and fold onto seat cushion. If the seat cushion is raised, fold it forward until it engages. Folding the centre seat backrest makes it possible to load longer objects. The outer seats can still be used for occupants. 9 Warning The load must not hinder handbrake operation or gearshifting. 93 Picture no: 17068t.tif Restoring the backrests or seat cushions 3 to their original position Guide the seat belt through the side bracket to protect against damage. To restore the backrest to an upright position, fold up, pressing the button on the backrest. Audibly engage the backrest in an upright position. 94 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17069t.tif Raised seat cushions: insert and adjust head restraints in backrests – see pages 5, 88. Fold back seat cushions, making sure the belt buckles are properly positioned. Attach the hooks of the luggage compartment cover to the head restraints – see page 98. The three-point seat belt for the centre rear seat can only be pulled from its inertia reel if the backrest is properly engaged. Picture no: 17070t.tif Luggage compartment enlargement, Estate with adjustable rear row of seats Fold backrests onto seat cushions Push the rear head restraints all the way down or remove – see page 88. Detach the hooks of the luggage compartment cover from the head restraints – see page 98. Slide front seat forward slightly. Safety net 3, see page 99. Disengage the backrest (single or split) using the sliders and fold it down onto the seat cushion. Notes on loading, see page 104. Return front seat to desired position. Picture no: 17071t.tif Raise the seat cushion and fold the backrest Lift rear seat cushions forward, single or split. Detach the hooks of the luggage compartment cover from the head restraints – see page 98. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17072t.tif Remove the outer rear head restraints. Push the centre head restraint all the way down – see page 88. Stow the removed head restraints in the cavity below the raised seat cushions. Picture no: 17073t.tif Disengage the backrest (single or split) using the sliders, fold it forward and engage. 95 Picture no: 17074t.tif Loading option behind the armrest in the rear seat backrest 3 Fold down the armrest, pulling the strap obliquely down (i.e. at an angle of 45°). Pull the handle and fold down the cover. Folding down the cover makes it possible to load long, narrow objects. The outer seats can still be used for occupants. 9 Warning The load must not hinder handbrake operation or gearshifting. To restore, fold the armrest back in position. 96 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17068t.tif Restoring the backrests or seat cushions 3 to their original position Guide the seat belts through the side brackets to protect against damage. To restore the backrest to an upright position, fold up, disengaging the backrest at the sliders. Audibly engage the backrest in an upright position. Picture no: 17075t.tif Raised seat cushions: insert and adjust head restraints in backrests – see pages 5, 88. Fold back seat cushions, making sure the belt buckles are properly positioned. Attach the hooks of the luggage compartment cover to the head restraints – see page 98. The three-point seat belt for the centre rear seat can only be pulled from its inertia reel if the backrest is properly engaged. Safety net 3, see page 99. Notes on loading, see page 104. Picture no: 18020t.tif Extending the luggage compartment, Astra TwinTop Loading area between rear seats Pull out the armrest by the strap. The armrest is held in place on the backrest with a retaining strap. To fully remove the armrest, disengage the bracket at the retaining strap. Pull the handle and fold down the cover. 9 Warning The load must not hinder handbrake operation or gearshifting. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17984t.tif Picture no: 17076t.tif Cover behind armrest can be locked from luggage compartment 3: turn handle 90°: Folding down the front passenger’s seat 3 Locked = Unlocked = Push front passenger’s seat head restraint all the way down or remove – see pages 5, 88. Handle horizontal Handle vertical Notes on loading, see page 104. Push front passenger’s seat back. Fold front passenger’s seat forward by raising release lever. To restore, press the release lever forward, restore the front seat backrest to an upright position and audibly engage. Picture no: 17077t.tif Luggage compartment cover Hatchback To remove, unhook the retaining straps from the tailgate. Pull cover from the side guides. Fit in reverse order. 97 98 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17078t.tif Estate To open Press handle on luggage compartment cover down. The cover automatically unrolls. To close Press handle on luggage compartment cover rearwards; the cover automatically engages in its end position. Do not place any heavy or sharp-edged objects on the cover. Picture no: 17079t.tif To cover the gap between the luggage compartment cover and the rear backrests, there is a cover on the cartridge. Attach the two hooks of the cover to the head restraint guide rods. If the safety net is mounted, run the hooks through the net mesh. Picture no: 17080t.tif Removing Open the luggage compartment cover and detach the hooks from the head restraints. Move release lever on right side of luggage compartment cover upward. Lift right cover and remove from brackets. Fitting Insert the luggage compartment cover in the recess on the left, press the release lever on the right side upward, insert the cover in the recess on the right, engage and press the lever down. Attach the hooks on the head restraints – see Fig. 17079 T. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17081t.tif Safety net 3, Estate The safety net can be mounted behind the rear seats or, if the rear seat backrests are folded and the seat cushions raised, behind the front seats. Fitting behind the rear seats Remove the luggage compartment cover – see left column. Unroll the safety net. There are two brackets in the roof frame. Hook the net rods into the brackets on one side and then the other. Slide forward to engage. Picture no: 17082t.tif Fixed rear row of seats: extend the safety net straps by adjusting the strap at the upper fastener in the loop of the strap (see Fig. 17085 T). Attach the straps in the eyelets in the floor on the right and left. Adjustable rear row of seats 3: extend the safety net straps by adjusting the strap at the upper fastener in the loop of the strap (see Fig. 17085 T). Attach the straps in the eyelets on the back of the right and left rear seat backrest. Install the luggage compartment cover – see left column. 99 Picture no: 17083t.tif Fitting behind front seats Raise the rear seat cushions – see pages 92 and 94. Unroll the safety net. There are two brackets in the roof frame above the front seats. Hook the net rods into the brackets on one side and then the other. Slide forward to engage. Fixed rear row of seats: extend the safety net straps by adjusting the strap at the upper fastener in the loop of the strap (see Fig. 17085 T). Attach the straps in the eyelets in the floor on the right and left. 100 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17084t.tif Adjustable rear row of seats 3: extend the safety net straps by adjusting the strap at the upper fastener in the loop of the strap (see Fig. 17085 T). Attach the straps in the brackets on the right and left raised seat cushions. Remove the outer rear head restraints and fold the backrests forward – see pages 92 and 94. Picture no: 17085t.tif Removing Detach the safety net belt straps by tipping up the length adjuster. Unhook the safety net rods from the brackets in the roof frame. Roll up the net and secure with a strap. Picture no: 17086t.tif Rails and hooks in the luggage compartment 3, Estate The side walls of the luggage compartment house two rails. Insert the hooks in the desired position in the rails: insert the hook in the upper groove on the rail and press in the lower groove. Pull off the hook to remove. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17087t.tif FlexOrganizer 3, Estate Flexible system for dividing the luggage compartment or securing loads in an Estate. The system consists of z adapters z variable partition net z mesh pockets for the side walls z hooks in the luggage compartment Components are mounted in the two guide rails in the side walls of the luggage compartment by means of adapters or hooks. Picture no: 17088t.tif Variable partition net Insert an adapter in each rail: fold up handle plate, insert adapter in upper and lower groove of rails, move to desired position. To lock the adapter, swivel the handle plate up. Compress the rods of the partition net slightly and insert in corresponding openings of the adapter. The longer rod must be inserted in the upper adapter. 101 Picture no: 17089t.tif Hooks and mesh pocket Insert the hooks in the desired position in the rails: insert the hook in the upper groove on the rail and press in the lower groove. The mesh pocket can be hung from the hooks. Removing Press the partition net rods together and remove from the adapters. Adapter: fold open the retainer, release the adapter from the lower groove and remove from the upper groove. Release the hooks from the rails. 102 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17090t.tif Picture no: 17092t.tif Lashing eyes 3 Cargo box 3 These enable loads to be secured in position in the luggage compartment using lashing straps 3 or a luggage net 3. Foldable box under the floor cover used to divide the luggage compartment. The cargo box may only be loaded when the backrests are engaged in an upright position. To remove the cargo box floor cover, remove first the right half then the left half. For models with towing equipment, first release the coupling ball bar fixing strap and thread this through the eye – see page 238. Installation in the reverse order. Picture no: 18024t.tif Luggage compartment blind, Astra TwinTop To open Disengage the luggage compartment blind from the recess on the right and left. Rolls up automatically. To close Grasp the handle, pull the blind towards the rear of the vehicle and engage in the recess on the right and left. Do not place any heavy or sharp-edged objects on the blind. There must be no objects outside of or on top of the luggage compartment blind when the roof is open or in the process of opening. The roof can only be operated when the luggage compartment blind is closed. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17978t.tif Easy Load (Electrically operated loading aid for the luggage compartment of the Astra TwinTop) The loading aid makes it possible to comfortably load the luggage compartment when the roof is open. The press of a button will raise the roof folded up in the luggage compartment 25 cm. This enlarges the load opening of the luggage compartment. z Open the boot lid. z Unhook the luggage compartment blind and attach it to the rear window frame. z Briefly press button ,: the folded roof is raised. The roof remains in this end position for approx. 9 minutes. Picture no: 17977t.tif z Do not load the luggage compartment higher than the load height marking (see Fig. 17973 T). Otherwise, both the roof and the load will be damaged. z Detach the luggage compartment blind from the rear window frame and engage it in the recess on the left and right. The blind must be perfectly flat when closed. z Briefly press button ,: the folded roof is lowered. z Close the boot lid. 103 Picture no: 17973t.tif 9 Warning Take care when operating the loading aid. Risk of injury. Make sure that nothing could be pinched. Make sure no one is in the action zone during operation. Risk of injury. This is especially important for children. Inform passengers accordingly. 6 104 Seats, Interior Note z Do not place objects on or near the luggage compartment blind. z Estate: mount the safety net 3 when transporting objects in the luggage compartment – see page 99. z The folded roof can only be lowered when the blind is closed. Otherwise, a warning buzzer will sound three times. z Estate: close the luggage compartment cover so the rear window does not reflect the objects. z Movement can only be stopped by pressing button ,. Holding the button depressed will change the direction of movement. z If the backrests are not folded down when transporting objects in the luggage compartment, they must be engaged in their upright position 3 – see pages 91, 93, 96. z An acoustic signal sounds to confirm that the roof has reached its upper or lower end position. z Only close the boot lid once the confirmation signal has sounded to indicate that the loading aid is in its lower end position. z Do not touch moving parts. z One minute before the end of the hold time for the raised loading aid, a warning buzzer will sound to remind you to lower the roof. z The loading aid is only operable when the vehicle is unlocked. Picture no: 17093t.tif Notes on loading the vehicle z Heavy objects in the luggage compartment should be placed against the engaged rear seat backrests 3 or, if the rear seat backrests are folded down, against the front seat backrests. If objects are to be stacked, the heavier objects should be placed at the bottom. Unsecured objects in the luggage compartment would be thrown forward with great force in the event of heavy braking, for example. z Secure heavy objects with lashing straps 3 attached to lashing eyes – see page 102. If heavy loads slip when the vehicle is braked heavily or driven around a bend, the handling of the vehicle may change. z Do not allow the load to protrude above the upper edge of the rear seat backrests, or above the upper edge of the front seat backrests if the rear seat backrests 3 are folded down. z Astra TwinTop: note the maximum loading height when the roof is open. See page 103, Fig. 17973 T. z The warning triangle 3 and first-aid kit (cushion) 3 must always be freely accessible. z Do not place any objects in front of the rear window or on the instrument panel. They are reflected in the glass, obstruct the driver’s view and will be thrown through the vehicle, for instance in the event of heavy braking. z The load must not hinder handbrake operation or gearshifting or impair the driver in any way. Seats, Interior 105 z Astra TwinTop: do not place any objects on the cover of the deployable anti-roll bars 3, behind the rear head restraints or in the luggage compartment outside of, on or next to the luggage compartment cover. z Do not place any objects in the deployment area of the airbags and deployable anti-roll bars 3 as this poses a risk of injury should the systems be triggered. z Do not drive with luggage compartment open when transporting bulky objects, for example, since toxic exhaust fumes could penetrate the interior. z Weights, payload and roof load – see page 318. z Driving with a roof load (see pages 196, 199, 234) increases the sensitivity of the vehicle to crosswinds and has a detrimental effect on vehicle handling owing to the vehicle’s higher centre of gravity. 9 Warning Failure to observe these descriptions can lead to injuries which may be fatal. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. Picture no: 17094t.tif Cigarette lighter 3 The cigarette lighter is located under the ashtray cover. The cover opens when pressed at the point indicated. Picture no: 17095t.tif Press in cigarette lighter. Switches off automatically once the element is glowing. Pull out lighter. 106 Seats, Interior Picture no: 18023t.tif Accessory socket 3 Some vehicles have an accessory socket for the connection of electrical accessories instead of a cigarette lighter. Use of the accessory socket while the engine is not running will discharge the battery. Picture no: 17096t.tif Estates have an additional accessory socket 3 in the luggage compartment. Do not damage the sockets by using unsuitable plugs. The maximum power consumption of electrical accessories must not exceed 120 watts. Do not connect any current-delivering accessories, e.g. electrical charging devices or batteries. Electrical accessories connected to the socket must comply with the electromagnetic compatibility requirements laid down in DIN VDE 40 839, otherwise vehicle malfunctions may occur. Picture no: 17094t.tif Ashtray 3 To be used only for ash and not for combustible rubbish. 9 Warning Failure to observe these descriptions can lead to injuries which may be fatal. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. Ashtray front The cover opens when pressed at the point indicated. Seats, Interior Picture no: 17097t.tif To empty, grip both sides of the ashtray insert at the spots illustrated and pull upwards. Picture no: 17098t.tif Rear ashtray 3 In the rear centre console. Pull out the ashtray by pushing on one of the sides. 107 Picture no: 17099t.tif To empty, open the ashtray, press the spring (arrow) and pull the ashtray straight out rearwards. Foldaway tables 3 On the front seat backrests. Open by pulling upward until it engages. Fold away by pressing down past the resistance point. Do not place any heavy objects on the table. 108 Seats, Interior Picture no: 17101t.tif Stowage compartments Glove compartment To open, pull handle upwards. The glove compartment shelf 3 can be removed: disengage the shelf by pulling on the front edge. Refit the shelf by sliding it into the side guide strips and engage it in the rear panel by pushing. The front of the open cover houses a pen holder and a coin compartment. Cooled glove compartment 3 – see page 155. Picture no: 17103t.tif Stowage compartment in front armrest 3 To open, press button and open upper part of armrest. Picture no: 17102t.tif Stowage compartment for glasses 3 On driver’s side: fold down to open. Do not store heavy objects in the stowage compartment. Sunvisors Use the sunvisor to protect from glare by pulling it down and swivelling it to the side 3. On vehicles with panoramic windscreen 3, close the sunvisors before moving the roof lining. Safety systems Safety systems Three-stage safety system Comprising: z three-point seat belts, z belt tensioners at the front seats, Seat belts.............................................. Three-point seat belts ......................... Testing the belts .................................. Belt tensioners...................................... Using the belts ..................................... Vauxhall Full-size airbag system ....... Mounting brackets 3 for ISO-FIX child restraint systems ........ Child restraint system 3 ...................... Rollover protection system 3.............. Exterior mirrors..................................... Aspherical exterior mirror 3 ............... Automatic anti-dazzle interior mirror 3.............................................. Sunvisors, glove compartment ........... Hazard warning lights......................... Head restraints .................................... Safety accessories 3 ........................... 110 110 111 111 113 115 127 128 130 132 132 132 132 132 133 133 z airbag systems for the driver, front passenger and outboard rear seats 3; for TwinTop 3, anti-roll bars behind the backrests. The three stages are activated in sequence depending on the severity of the accident: z The automatic seat belt locking devices prevent the belt strap from being pulled out and thus ensure that the vehicle occupants are retained in their seats. z The front seat belt buckles are pulled downwards. As a result, the seat belts are instantaneously tightened and the occupants are made aware of the deceleration of the vehicle at a very early stage. This reduces the stress placed on the body. z In the event of a severe accident, the airbag systems and deployable anti-roll bars 3 also deploy, forming safety cushions for the occupants. The front airbags are inflated in two stages based on the severity of the collision. 109 9 Warning The airbag systems and anti-roll bars 3 serve to supplement the three-point seat belts and belt tensioners. The seat belts must therefore always be worn. Disregard of these instructions could lead to injuries or endanger life. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. Read the instructions supplied with the child restraint system! 110 Safety systems Seat belts 9 Warning Always wear your seat belt, and that means also in urban traffic and when you are a rear seat passenger. It can save your life! Seat belts are only intended for one person. They are not suitable for anyone under 12 years of age or under 150 cm tall. For children up to 12 years of age, we recommend the Vauxhall child restraint system – see page 128. Pregnant women must always wear a seat belt – see page 113. In the event of an accident, persons not wearing seat belts endanger their fellow occupants and themselves. Control indicator X 3 for the seat belt – see page 38. Picture no: 16981t.tif Three-point seat belts The vehicle is equipped with three-point seat belts with automatic retractors and locking devices, allowing freedom of body movement although the spring tensioned belts always ensure a snug fit. For information on correct seating position – see pages 87, 113, 117. The belt has a "vehicle sensitive retractor" which is designed to lock during heavy acceleration or deceleration in any direction. Safety systems Testing the belts Actuation of belt tensioners Indicated by illumination of control indicator v - see next page. Please check all parts of the belt system occasionally for damage and correct operation. Have damaged parts replaced. In case of an accident, please replace overstretched belts and triggered belt tensioners. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The belt tensioners must be replaced after activation. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. If the seat belts are undamaged the operation thereof is unaffected, even if the belt tensioners have been triggered. Do not perform any alterations on the belts, their anchorages, the automatic retractors or the belt buckles. Make sure that belts are not damaged or trapped by sharp-edged objects. 111 Important information – see page 112. Picture no: 17104t.tif Belt tensioners The front seat belt systems are equipped with belt tensioners. In the event of a headon or rear-end collision of a certain severity, the belt buckles are pulled down, thus tightening the belts. 112 Safety systems 9 Warning Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. Have your Car Pass to hand when consulting a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Important Picture no: 17105t.tif Control indicator v for belt tensioners The belt tensioners are electronic monitored together with the airbag systems and the deployable anti-roll bars 3. Their operational readiness is indicated by control indicator v on the instrument panel. When the ignition is switched on, the control indicator v illuminates for approx. 4 seconds. If it does not illuminate, does not go off after 4 seconds or illuminates whilst driving, there is a fault in the belt tensioner system, airbag systems or the deployable anti-roll bars 3 - see page 121. The belt tensioners, airbag systems or deployable anti-roll bars 3 may fail to trigger in the event of an accident. Deployment of the belt tensioners is indicated by continuous illumination of v. z Accessories and other objects not specifically approved for your vehicle type must not be affixed or placed within the action zone of the belt tensioners (near the belt buckles) as this could result in injury if the belt tensioners are triggered. z Do not make any modifications to the components of the belt tensioners, as this will render the vehicle unroadworthy. 9 Warning Improper handling (e.g. removal or installation) can activate the belt tensioners – risk of injury. z The belt tensioner and airbag system control electronics can be found in the centre console area. In order to avoid malfunctions, do not store magnetic objects in this area. z We recommend that you have the front seats removed by a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer in the event of actuation of the belt tensioners. z The belt tensioners only actuate once. Please replace belt tensioners that have been triggered. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. z Applicable safety directives must always be observed when disposing of the vehicle. For this reason, disposal should be performed by an authorised recycling company. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Safety systems Picture no: 17106t.tif Using the belts Fitting seat belts Pull the belt out of the retractor and guide it across the body, making certain that it is not twisted. Insert the latch plate into the buckle. The front seat backrest must not be tilted back too far or the seat belt will not operate properly. The recommended angle of inclination is 25°. Make sure that the lap belt is not twisted and that it fits snugly across the body. Tension the belt frequently while driving by tugging the diagonal part of the belt. Picture no: 17107t.tif 9 Warning On pregnant women in particular, the lap belt must be positioned as low as possible across the pelvis so as not to put too much pressure on the abdomen. Bulky clothing prevents the belt from fitting properly. The belt must not rest against hard or fragile objects in the pockets of your clothing (e.g. ballpoint pens, keys, spectacles) because these could cause injury. Do not place any objects (e.g. handbags, mobile phones) between the belt and your body. 113 Picture no: 17108t.tif Height adjustment 3 of front seat belt upper anchorage point: 1. Pull belt out slightly. 2. Press down button on adjuster slide. 3. Move adjuster slide up or down. 4. Allow sliding adjuster to audibly latch. Do not adjust height while driving. 6 114 Safety systems Three-point seat belts on rear outer seats When not in use, pass seat belts through side holders 3 as shown in Fig. 17063 T on page 91. Three-point seat belt of centre rear seat 3 The belt can only be pulled from the inertia reel when the backrests are upright and properly engaged – see page 91. Picture no: 16981t.tif Adjust height such that the belt passes over the wearer’s shoulder and rests against the shoulder. It must not pass over the neck or upper arm. Picture no: 17109t.tif Removing the belt To remove the belt, depress the red pushbutton on the buckle; the belt will retract automatically. Three-point seat belts of rear seats in Astra TwinTop In order to prevent the flutter noise caused by the belts when the roof and windows are open, the seat belts can be secured behind the cushion hatch when the rear seats are not occupied. Safety systems Picture no: 17009t.tif Vauxhall Full-size airbag system The Vauxhall Full-size airbag system comprises several individual systems. Front airbag system The front airbag system will be triggered in the event of a serious accident involving a frontal impact and forms safety cushions for the driver and front passenger. The forward movement of the driver and front passenger is checked and the risk of injuries to the upper body and head thereby substantially reduced. Picture no: 17110t.tif Side airbag system The side airbag is triggered in the event of a side-on collision to form a safety cushion for the driver or front passenger in the respective door area. This substantially reduces the risk of injury to the upper body and pelvis. Picture no: 17351t.tif 115 Curtain airbag system 3 The curtain airbag system triggers in case of a side-on collision and provides a safety barrier in the head area on the respective side of the vehicle. This reduces the risk of injury to the head considerably in case of a side-on collision. 116 Safety systems Exception: Front passenger’s seat with seat occupancy recognition system 3. The seat occupancy recognition system deactivates the front and side airbags on the passenger’s side if the front passenger’s seat is unoccupied or a Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 has been fitted to the front passenger’s seat. Seat occupancy recognition – see page 122. Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 – see page 128. Vauxhall Full-size airbag system z seat occupancy recognition 3, Examples of events triggering the front airbag system: Front airbag The front airbag system is identified by the word AIRBAG on the steering wheel and above the glove compartment. z the control indicator for Vauxhall child restraint systems y with transponders 3 in the instrument panel. z Impact against a non-yielding obstacle: the front airbags are triggered at low vehicle speed. The front airbag system will be triggered: z Impact against a yielding obstacle (such as another vehicle): the front airbags are only triggered at a higher vehicle speed. Picture no: 17111t.tif The front airbag system comprises: z an airbag with inflator in the steering wheel and a second one in the instrument panel, z control electronics with impact sensors, z the airbag systems control indicator v in the instrument panel, Picture no: 17112t.tif z depending on the severity of the accident, z depending on the type of impact, z within the range shown in the illustration, z independent of side airbag and curtain airbag system 3. Safety systems Picture no: 17009t.tif When triggered, the front airbags inflate in milliseconds to form a safety cushion for the driver and front passenger. The forward movement of the front seat occupants is checked, thereby substantially reducing the risk of injury to the upper body and head. No impairment of view will occur, because the airbags inflate and deflate so quickly. Picture no: 17350t.tif 9 Warning The front airbag system provides optimum protection when the seat, backrest and head restraint are correctly adjusted: adjust the driver’s seat according to the occupant’s height such that with the driver sitting upright the steering wheel is held in the area of its upper spokes with the driver’s arms slightly bent. The passenger’s seat should be as far back as possible, with the backrest upright – see pages 3, 87. Do not place the head, body, hands or feet on the covers of the airbag systems. Do not place any objects in the area in which the airbags inflate. Important information – see page 124. 117 Picture no: 16981t.tif 9 Warning The three-point seat belt must be correctly fitted – see page 113. The front airbag system will not be triggered in the event of z the ignition being switched off, z minor frontal collisions, z accidents in which the vehicle overturns, z collisions involving a side or rear-impact that is to say, if it would not be of benefit to the occupants. 118 Safety systems 9 Warning Seat belts must therefore always be worn. The front airbag system serves to supplement the three-point seat belts. If you do not wear your seat belt you risk being seriously injured, or even thrown from the vehicle, in the event of an accident. In the event of an accident the belt helps to keep you in the correct seating position, so that the front airbag system can provide you with effective protection. In addition, the front airbag system will not be triggered for the front passenger in model variants with seat occupancy recognition 3 if z the front passenger’s seat is unoccupied, z there is a properly fitted Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3. Seat occupancy recognition – see page 122. Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 – see page 128. Picture no: 17113t.tif Side airbags The side airbag system is identified by the word AIRBAG on the outboard sides of the front seat backrests. The side airbag system comprises: z an airbag with inflator in the back of the driver’s and front passenger’s seat respectively, z the control electronics, z the side-impact sensors, z the airbag systems control indicator v in the instrument panel, z seat occupancy recognition 3, z the control indicator for Vauxhall child restraint systems y with transponders 3 in the instrument panel. Picture no: 17114t.tif The side airbag system will be triggered: z depending on the severity of the accident, z depending on the type of impact, z within the range shown in the illustration on the centre door pillar of the driver’s or front passenger’s side, z independently of the front airbag system. Exception: Front passenger’s seat with seat occupancy recognition system 3. The seat occupancy recognition system deactivates the front and side airbags on the passenger’s side if the front passenger’s seat is unoccupied or a Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 has been fitted to the front passenger’s seat. Seat occupancy recognition – see page 122. Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 – see page 128. Safety systems 9 Warning There must be no objects in the area in which the airbag inflates or in the area between the seat backs and the vehicle body. Do not place the hands or arms on the covers of the airbag systems. Important information – see page 124. The three-point seat belt must always be correctly fitted – see page 113. Picture no: 17110t.tif When triggered, the side airbag inflates within milliseconds to form a safety cushion for the driver or front passenger in the respective door area. This substantially reduces the risk of injury to the upper body and pelvis in the event of a side-on collision. The side airbags will not be triggered in the event of z the ignition being switched off, z frontal collisions, z accidents in which the vehicle overturns, z collisions involving a rear-impact, z collisions involving a side-impact outside the passenger’s cell. 119 In addition, the side airbag system will not be triggered for the front passenger in model variants with seat occupancy recognition 3 if z the front passenger’s seat is unoccupied, z there is a properly fitted Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3. Seat occupancy recognition – see page 122. Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 – see page 128. 120 Safety systems Picture no: 17115t.tif Picture no: 17114t.tif Curtain airbag 3 The curtain airbag system is identified by the word AIRBAG on the roof pillar trim. The curtain airbag system will be triggered: The curtain airbag system comprises: z depending on the type of impact, z an airbag with inflator in the roof frame on the driver’s and front passenger’s side respectively, z the control electronics, z the side-impact sensors, z the airbag systems control indicator v in the instrument panel. z depending on the severity of the accident, z within the range shown in the illustration on the centre door pillar of the driver’s or front passenger’s side, z together with the side airbag system, z irrespective of seat occupancy recognition, z independently of the front airbag system. Picture no: 17351t.tif When the curtain airbag is triggered it inflates within milliseconds and provides a safety barrier in the head area on the respective side of the vehicle. This reduces the risk of injury to the head considerably in case of a side-impact. Safety systems 121 9 Warning 9 Warning There must be no objects in the area in which the airbag inflates. Do not place the hands or arms on the covers of the airbag systems. Important information – see page 124. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. Have your Car Pass to hand when consulting a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The three-point seat belt must always be correctly fitted – see page 113. The curtain airbags will not be triggered in the event of z the ignition being switched off, z frontal collisions, z accidents in which the vehicle overturns, z collisions involving a rear-impact, z collisions involving a side-impact outside the passenger’s cell. Picture no: 17105t.tif Control indicator v for airbag systems The airbag systems are electronic monitored together with seat occupancy recognition 3, the belt tensioners and the deployable anti-roll bars 3. Their operational readiness is indicated by control indicator v on the instrument panel. When the ignition is switched on, the control indicator v illuminates for approx. 4 seconds. If it does not illuminate, does not go off after 4 seconds or illuminates whilst driving, there is a fault in the airbag systems, seat occupancy recognition 3, the belt tensioners or the deployable anti-roll bars 3 - see page 112. The systems may fail to trigger in the event of an accident. Deployment of the airbags is indicated by continuous illumination of v. 122 Safety systems Seat occupancy recognition 3 The seat occupancy recognition system deactivates the front and side airbags for the front passenger if the front passenger’s seat is not occupied or a Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 is fitted on the front passenger’s seat. The curtain airbag system 3 remains activated. The control indicator for seat occupancy recognition y is located in the instrument panel. If control indicator y illuminates for approx. 4 seconds after the ignition is switched on, the vehicle is equipped with seat occupancy recognition – see next page, Fig. 17117 T. If a Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 is installed, control indicator y illuminates once the ignition has been switched on and the system has detected the seat. Only then can a child restraint system with transponders 3 be used on the front passenger’s seat. 9 Warning Only Vauxhall child restraint systems with transponders 3 can be fitted on the front passenger’s seat. Use of systems without transponders poses a risk of fatal injury. Vauxhall child restraint systems with transponders 3 can be identified by a sticker. Picture no: 17116t.tif Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition are also identified by a sticker on the lower panel of the front passenger’s seats – see illustration above. Vauxhall child restraint systems with transponders 3 are automatically detected if correctly fitted to the front passenger’s seat. When this type of child restraint system is in use on the front passenger’s seat, the front and side airbag systems for the front passenger’s seat are deactivated. The curtain airbag system remains activated. Pay attention to control indicator y for seat occupancy recognition 3 - see Fig. 17117 T. Note On the Astra TwinTop, there may be interference in radio reception of certain frequencies in the medium waveband when the roof is open and the front passenger’s seat is unoccupied. Safety systems Control indicator y for Vauxhall child restraint systems with transponders 3 The presence of a Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 is indicated by the illumination of control indicator y in the instrument panel once the ignition has been switched on and the seat occupancy recognition system has detected the child restraint system. 123 If the control indicator y flashes even though there is correctly installed child restraint system with transponders 3, there is a fault-risk of fatal injury to the child. Fit child restraint system to rear seat. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17117t.tif If the control indicator y does not illuminate whilst driving, the front and side airbag have not been deactivated on the passenger’s side. Risk of fatal injury to the child - fit child restraint system to rear seat. Have cause of fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. If the child restraint system is not correctly installed or the transponder is faulty, the control indicator y flashes. Check for correct installation of child restraint system. To install the child restraint system with transponders 3, see the instructions enclosed with the system. If no Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 is installed, the control indicator y must neither illuminate nor flash, since this indicates that the front passenger’s airbag systems would not be triggered. Have the cause of fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 9 Warning If the Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 has been fitted according to the instructions, the control indicator y for Vauxhall restraint systems with transponders must illuminate in the instrument panel when the ignition is switched on. If the control indicator y does not illuminate whilst driving, the airbag systems have not been deactivated on the passenger’s side. Risk of fatal injury. In this case, fit child restraint system to rear seat. Have cause of fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 124 Safety systems Important z Do not affix or place accessories or other objects in the deployment area or the airbag systems or deployable anti-roll bars 3 as this could result in injuries if the components are triggered. z Do not place any objects between the airbag systems / anti-roll bar covers 3 and the occupants. Risk of injury. z Use the hooks in the roof frame only to hang up light articles of clothing or coat hangers. Do not place any objects in the pockets of the hanging items – risk of injury. z The control electronics of the airbag systems, belt tensioners and deployable anti-roll bars 3 are located in the centre console area. Do not store any magnetic objects in the area as they could cause malfunction. z Do not bond or use other materials to cover the steering wheel, instrument panel, front seat backrests and roof frame, in the area of the airbags, the passenger’s seat cushion or the covers of the deployable anti-roll bars 3. z Use only a dry cloth or interior cleaner to clean the steering wheel, instrument panel, front seat backrests, roof frame and seat cushion of the front passenger’s seat. Do not use any aggressive cleaning agents. z Only protective covers which are approved for your Astra with side airbag system may be fitted on the front seats. When fitting the protective covers, make sure that the airbag units on the outboard sides of the front seat backrests are not covered. z The airbag systems are triggered independently of each other based on the severity of the accident and the type of impact. The side airbag system and the curtain airbag system 3 are triggered together. z Astra TwinTop: the deployable anti-roll bars 3 are deployed together with the front and side airbag systems depending on the severity of the impact. z Each airbag or deployable anti-roll bar 3 can only be deployed once. Have deployed components replaced immediately. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. z The speeds, directions of movement and deformation properties of the vehicles, and the properties of the obstacle concerned, determine the severity of the accident and triggering of the airbags. The degree of damage to your vehicle and the resulting repair costs alone are not indicative that the criteria for triggering of the airbags were met. z Do not make any modifications to components of the airbag systems or the anti-roll bars 3 as this would render the vehicle unroadworthy. 9 Warning The systems can be triggered abruptly and cause injury if they are handled improperly. z We recommend having the steering wheel, the instrument panel, all panelling parts, the door seals, the handles and the seats removed by your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. z Applicable safety directives must always be observed when disposing of the vehicle. For this reason, disposal should be performed by an authorised recycling company. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Safety systems z Persons weighing less than 35 kg should only travel on the rear seats. This does not apply to children who are travelling in child restraint systems with transponders 3. z In vehicles with seat occupancy recognition 3, do not place any heavy objects on the front passenger’s seat otherwise the airbag systems for the front passenger’s seat may be triggered in the event of an accident. z In vehicles with seat occupancy recognition 3, to prevent malfunctions do not use protective covers or seat cushions on the front passenger’s seat. 125 z In order to prevent malfunctions when using a Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders 3 on the front passenger’s seat, no objects (e.g. plastic sheet, stickers or heated mats) may be placed under the child restraint system. 9 Warning Child restraint systems as well as other objects must never be carried on the lap of passengers; risk of fatal injury. If carried in this way, child restraint systems with transponders 3 in vehicles with seat occupancy recognition 3 could lead to front passenger’s airbag systems not being triggered in the event of an accident. Picture no: 17118t.tif Use of child restraint systems 3 on the front passenger’s seat in vehicles with airbag systems, but without seat occupancy recognition 3 9 Warning No child restraint system 3 may be installed on front passenger’s seat. Danger to life. Model variants with front passenger’s airbag can be identified by the word AIRBAG over the glove compartment and the warning sticker on the side of the instrument panel, visible when the passenger’s door is open – see illustration. 6 126 Safety systems Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition are identified by a sticker on the lower panel of the front passenger’s seat – see Fig. 17116 T. Picture no: 17119t.tif The side airbag system is identified by the word AIRBAG on the outboard sides of the front seat backrests. Seat occupancy recognition 3 – see page 122. Picture no: 17116t.tif Use of child restraint systems 3 on front passenger’s seat in vehicles with airbag systems and seat occupancy recognition 3 9 Warning Only Vauxhall child restraint systems with transponders 3 can be fitted on the front passenger’s seats. Use of systems without transponders poses a risk of fatal injury. Safety systems Picture no: 17117t.tif Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition can also be identified by control indicator y in the instrument panel. If control indicator y illuminates for approx. 4 seconds after the ignition is switched on, the vehicle is equipped with seat occupancy recognition – see page 122. The seat occupancy recognition system detects Vauxhall child restraint systems with transponders 3 and deactivates the front and side airbag systems for the front passenger’s seat. The curtain airbag system remains activated. For seat occupancy recognition – see page 122. Picture no: 17424t.tif Vauxhall child restraint systems with transponders 3 can be identified by a sticker on the child restraint system – see illustration. 127 Picture no: 17091t.tif Mounting brackets 3 for ISO-FIX child restraint systems The brackets located between the backrest and seat cushion are used for mounting ISO-FIX child restraint systems. The instructions accompanying the ISO-FIX child restraint system are to be expressly followed. Only ISO-FIX child restraint systems approved for the vehicle may be used. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 128 Safety systems Child restraint system 3 The Vauxhall child restraint system is designed specifically for your Vauxhall and thus provides optimum safety for your child in the event of impact. If a different child safety seat is used, follow the manufacturers’ instructions for fitting and use. Selecting the right system Your child should be transported facing rearward in the vehicle as long as possible. Change the system when the height of the child is such that the head extends over the top of the system and is no longer supported at eye level. The child’s neck area is still very weak. In the event of an accident, they are subjected to less stress in the semi-prone rearward position than when upright. Permissible options for fitting a child safety seat1) Weight and age class2) On front passenger’s seat On outer rear seats On centre rear seat3) 0: up to 10 kg or approx. 10 months B 1, + U, + U 0+: up to 13 kg or approx. 2 years B 1, + U, + U I: 9 to 18 kg or approx. 8 months to 4 years B 2, + U, + U II: 15 to 25 kg or approx. 3 to 7 years – U U III: 22 to 36 kg or approx. 6 to 12 years – U U 1) 2) 3) For reasons of safety, we recommend that the child safety seat be installed on one of the outer rear seats. We recommend the use of each system until the child reaches the upper weight limit. Not on Astra TwinTop. Safety systems B1 = Limited, only with seat occupancy recognition and Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders. If the child restraint system is being secured using a three-point seat belt, move seat height adjustment 3 to uppermost position. Move front passenger’s seat as far back as possible and move front passenger’s seat belt anchorage point to lowest position. B2 = Limited, only with seat occupancy recognition and Vauxhall child restraint system with transponders. If the child restraint system is being secured using a three-point seat belt, move seat height adjustment 3 to uppermost position. Move front passenger’s seat as far back as possible so that vehicle safety belt runs from anchorage point towards the front. U = Universal suitability in conjunction with three-point seat belt. + – = Vehicle seat with ISO-FIX mounting available. When mounting with ISO-FIX, only ISO-FIX child restraint systems that have been approved for the vehicle may be used. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. = No child restraint system permitted in this weight class. 129 Note z Children under 12 years or under 150 cm tall should only travel in an appropriate child safety seat. z When transporting children, use the child restraint systems suitable for the child’s weight. z Ensure correct installation of child restraint system, see the instructions enclosed with the system. z The covers of the Vauxhall child restraint system can be wiped clean. z Do not stick anything on the child restraint systems and do not cover them with any other materials. z Only allow the child to enter and exit on the side of the vehicle facing away from the road. z A child restraint system which has been subjected to stress in an accident must be replaced. 130 Safety systems Rollover protection system 3 The Astra TwinTop is equipped with rollover protection with reinforced windscreen frame and anti-roll bars behind the rear seat head restraints. Depending on the model variant, the anti-roll bars are either fixed or deploy automatically in the event of an impact of a certain severity. The subsequent description only regards the model variant with automatically deployed anti-roll bars 3. Picture no: 17974t.tif In the event of a rollover, the anti-roll bars deploy upwards in a matter of milliseconds. They also deploy together with the front and side airbag systems, helping to optimise occupant protection. The system deploys whether the roof is open or closed. Roof operation is not possible if the anti-roll bars are extended. Picture no: 17105t.tif Control indicator v for anti-roll bars The deployable anti-roll bars are monitored electronically together with the belt tensioners and the airbag systems. Their operational readiness is indicated by control indicator v in the instrument panel. When the ignition is switched on, the control indicator v illuminates for approx. 4 seconds. If it does not illuminate, does not go out after 4 seconds or illuminates whilst driving, there is a fault in or deployment of the anti-roll bars, belt tensioners and airbag systems – see page 112. The systems may fail to trigger in the event of an accident. Deployment of the anti-roll bars is indicated by continuous illumination of v. Safety systems Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 9 Warning The roof cannot be closed or opened if the anti-roll bars are extended. The antiroll bars must first be retracted. If an attempt is made to operate the roof while the anti-roll bars are extended, a continuous signal will sound as a warning. Picture no: 17992t.tif Extended anti-roll bars Can be retracted (e.g. in order to close the roof after a collision). Press the lever between the rods of an antiroll bar to unlock the system. Push the antiroll bar all the way down until it engaged. Fit the cover. Repeat the procedure on the other anti-roll bar. Control indicator v, however, will remain illuminated and the anti-roll bars will not deploy in the event of another collision. 131 Note z Do not place any objects on the covers of the anti-roll bars behind the head restraints. They would be propelled through the vehicle in an uncontrolled fashion should the anti-roll bars deploy. Such objects could also prevent the antiroll bars from extending. z Do not operate the roof while the antiroll bars are extended. Parts of the roof could be damaged during such operation. z Deployment of the anti-roll bars is indicated by illumination of control indicator v. z Manually retracted anti-roll bars will not deploy in the event of a collision. z After deployment, the anti-roll bar system must be serviced immediately. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 132 Safety systems Picture no: 17120t.tif Exterior mirrors For the safety of pedestrians, the exterior mirrors will swing out of their normal mounting position if they are bumped with sufficient force. Reposition the mirror by applying slight pressure to the mirror housing. Aspherical exterior mirror 3 Increases the field of view. Estimating the distance away of vehicles following you is only possible to a limited extent because of slight distortion. Picture no: 17121t.tif Automatic anti-dazzle interior mirror 3 Dazzle at night is automatically reduced. With the ignition off, the mirror does not dim. Setting – see page 6. Sunvisors, glove compartment The mirror covers in the sunvisors and the glove compartment should be closed whilst driving. Picture no: 16991t.tif Hazard warning lights If the airbags are triggered, the hazard warning lights are automatically activated and the central locking system unlocks all doors. Press button ¨ twice to switch off the hazard warning lights. Safety systems 133 Head restraints Safety accessories 3 Do not mount any object or component on the head restraint unless it has been specifically released for your Astra for this purpose. They impair the protective properties of the head restraint and could be thrown forward through the vehicle in the event of heavy braking or an accident. The wide range of Vauxhall accessories allows you to equip your Astra in accordance with your own wishes. In addition to safety accessories, items for improving comfort and a complete range of vehicle care products you will find many articles which will be of great value to you when needed. "Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories" guarantee high quality and accurate fit. Picture no: 17011t.tif Active head restraints 3 In the event of a rear-end impact, the active head restraints automatically tilt forwards. The head is more effectively supported by the head restraint and the danger of whiplash in the neck area is reduced. Active head restraints are identified by the lettering ACTIVE on the head restraint guide sleeves. Your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer will be happy to advise you, for example with regard to: z Vauxhall child restraint systems z Tow ropes z Tow rods z Jump leads z Spare bulb kit z Spare fuse kit z Halogen fog lights z Mudflaps z Warning triangle z First-aid kit (cushion) 134 Lighting Lighting Automatic dipped beam activation 3 Front fog lights > 3............................ Fog tail light r .................................... Turn signals, hazard warning lights... Reversing lights.................................... Headlight range adjustment ? .......... Adaptive Forward Lighting 3 (AFL) .. Door-to-door lighting function ........... Parking lights 3 ................................... Instrument illumination, information display illumination ...... Courtesy light ....................................... Puddle light 3 ...................................... Battery discharge protection.............. Light covers.......................................... Headlights when driving abroad ....... Model variants with daytime running lights 3: parking lights are on when the ignition is switched on and the light switch is set to 7 or AUTO. Dipped beam is on when the engine is running. 135 135 135 135 135 136 137 138 138 138 139 140 140 140 140 The daytime running lights switch off when the ignition is switched off. Follow the regulations of the country in which you are driving when using daytime running lights and front fog lights 3. Driving abroad – see page 140. Picture no: 17122t.tif Exterior lights Turn light switch: 7 = Off 8 = Parking lights 9 = Dipped beam, main beam Dipped beam, main beam and headlight flash – see page 15. In positions 8 and 9, the tail lights and number plate lights are also on. Control indicator 8 – see page 39. Lighting 135 Fog tail light r On = Off = Press r, r illuminates in instrument panel Press r again or switch ignition or light off The fog tail light can only be switched on both the ignition and dipped beam / parking lights are on. The vehicle fog tail light are deactivated when towing. Picture no: 17123t.tif Automatic dipped beam activation 3 Light switch to AUTO: dipped beam comes on automatically when the engine is running if outside light conditions warrant such. The exterior lights switch off when the ignition is switched off. For reasons of safety, the light switch should always remain in the AUTO position. Picture no: 17124t.tif Front fog lights > 3 On = Off = Press >, > illuminates in instrument panel Press > again or switch ignition or light off The front fog lights can only be switched on when both the ignition and lights are on. Turn signals, hazard warning lights see page 15. Reversing lights Come on when reverse gear is engaged and ignition is switched on. 136 Lighting Vehicles without level control system z Front seats occupied = 0 z All seats occupied = 1 z All seats occupied and luggage compartment load = 2 z Driver’s seat occupied and luggage compartment load = 3 Vehicles with level control system Picture no: 17125t.tif Headlight range adjustment ? Manual headlight range adjustment With dipped beam switched on, adjust headlight range in four steps to suit vehicle load. Turn wheel against resistance and click it to the required position. Correct adjustment of the headlight range reduces dazzle for other road users. Automatic Level Control system 3 – see page 216. z Front seats occupied = 0 z All seats occupied = 1 z All seats occupied and luggage compartment load = 1 z Driver’s seat occupied and luggage compartment load = 2 Automatic headlight range adjustment 3 On vehicles with Xenon headlights, the range of the headlights is adjusted automatically based on vehicle load. Lighting Picture no: 17126t.tif Adaptive Forward Lighting 3 (AFL) AFL improves lighting in curves (curve lighting) on vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlight system. Picture no: Curve lighting The Xenon light beam pivots based on steering wheel position and speed (from approx. 6 mph (10 km/h)). The headlights shine at an angle of up to 15° to the right or left of the direction of travel. Motorway lighting At higher speeds and continuous straight ahead travel, the dipped beam automatically raises slightly, thereby increasing headlight range. 137 Picture no: 17127t.tif Control indicator light B Illuminated: fault in system. The system is not ready for operation. If the cornering light swivelling device fails, the relevant dipped beam is switched off. The corresponding front fog light is automatically switched on for reasons of safety. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. If control indicator B flashes for approx. 4 seconds after the ignition is switched on, the headlights have been set to symmetrical dipped beam; see "Headlights when driving abroad" on page 140. 138 Lighting Picture no: 17128t.tif Picture no: 17129t.tif Door-to-door lighting function Parking lights 3 The dipped beam and reversing lights come on for approx. 30 seconds after the driver’s door is closed, serving as door-todoor lighting after exiting from the vehicle. The front parking light and tail light of one side of the vehicle can be activated when parking: To activate function: 1. Switch off ignition. 2. Ignition off. 2. Remove ignition key. 3. Open driver’s door. 4. Pull turn signal stalk toward steering wheel. If the driver’s door is left open, the lights will go out after two minutes. Door-to-door lighting can be deactivated by inserting the key in the starter switch or by pulling the turn signal stalk toward the steering wheel again while the driver’s door is open. 1. Set light switch to 7 or AUTO 3. 3. Move turn signal stalk all the way up (right parking light) or down (left parking light). An acoustic signal sounds and control indicator O illuminates briefly in the instrument panel to indicate activation. To switch it off, switch on the ignition or move the turn signal stalk in the opposite direction. Picture no: 17130t.tif Instrument illumination, information display illumination Comes on when ignition is switched on. Brightness can be adjusted when the exterior lights are on: push to release knob k and then turn it clockwise or anticlockwise and hold until the desired brightness is obtained. Display mode 3 – see page 58. Lighting Picture no: 17131t.tif Courtesy light Front courtesy light Comes on automatically when the vehicle is unlocked with the remote control, when a door is opened or when the key is removed from the starter switch after the ignition is switched off. Goes off automatically after a delay when the doors are closed or immediately when the ignition is switched on or the doors are locked. To operate manually from inside when the doors are closed: On Off = = Press button c Press button c again Picture no: 17132t.tif Front reading lights 3 Left and right reading lights are individually operable. With ignition on: On Off = = Press button a Press button a again 139 Picture no: 17133t.tif Courtesy lights and rear reading lights 3 Centre switch position: the rear courtesy light comes on together with the front one when a door is open. The rear reading lights on the left and right can be switched on separately. With ignition on: On Off = = Switch position I Switch position 0 140 Lighting Entry lighting 3 After unlocking the vehicle, the instrument and switch lighting come on for a few seconds. Door handle lighting 3 When the exterior lights are on, the interior front door handles are illuminated. Illuminated mirror in the sunvisors 3 The lighting switches on when the cover is opened. Glove compartment lighting on when lid is open. Cigarette lighter and ashtray illumination 3 Comes on when ignition is switched on. Luggage compartment lighting Comes on when the boot lid / tailgate is opened. Automatically regulated centre console lighting 3 Spotlight in housing of interior mirror. Daylight-dependent, automatically regulated centre console lighting with ignition switched on. Puddle light 3 After unlocking the vehicle, the number plate lights come on for a few seconds. Battery discharge protection Do as follows to prevent glare: To prevent the battery from becoming discharged, the courtesy light, reading lights, luggage compartment lighting and glove compartment lighting switch off automatically 10 minutes after the ignition is switched off. Vehicles with halogen headlight system or Xenon headlight system 3 Have the headlights adjusted by a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Light covers The inside of the light covers may mist up briefly in poor, wet and cold weather conditions, in heavy rain or after washing. The mist disappears quickly by itself; to help, switch on the lights. Headlights when driving abroad The asymmetrical dipped beam increases the field of vision on the passenger’s side of the lane. This causes glare for oncoming traffic if the vehicle is driven in countries where traffic drives on the opposite side of the road. Vehicles with Adaptive Forward Lighting 3 (AFL) 1. Pull and hold stalk for main beam on steering wheel (headlight flash). 2. Switch on ignition. 3. After approx. 3 seconds, an acoustic signal sounds and then AFL control indicator B flashes approx. 4 seconds. After the switch, AFL control indicator B flashes for 4 seconds each time the ignition is switched on. To return to asymmetrical dipped beam, pull and hold the main beam stalk again, switch on the ignition and wait for the acoustic signal. AFL control indicator B will then discontinue flashing. Control indicator B – see page 42. Windows, sunroof Windows, sunroof 141 9 Warning Take care when operating the electrically operated windows 3 and the sunroof 3. Risk of injury, particularly to children. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. If there are children on the rear seat, switch on the child safety system 3 for the electrically operated door windows. Electrically operated door windows 3 141 Panoramic windscreen 3 .................... 144 Sunroof 3 ............................................. 144 Keep a close watch on the windows and sunroof when closing them. Ensure that nothing becomes trapped in them as they move. To prevent unauthorised operation, switch ignition off, remove ignition key 3 and open driver’s door. Electrically operated door windows 3 The electrically operated door windows can be used z with ignition on, z within 5 minutes of switching ignition off 3, z within 5 minutes of switching ignition key to position 1. Operational readiness ends when the driver’s door is opened. Picture no: 17134t.tif Operated via two or four 3 switches in the driver’s door handle. The front switches are for the driver and front passenger’s doors. The rear switches 3 are for the rear doors. Additional switches are located in the front passenger’s door and rear doors 3. For incremental operation, briefly pull or press the switch. For automatic opening or closing, pull or press the switch longer. Pull or press the switch again to stop the movement. 142 Windows, sunroof Picture no: 17135t.tif Picture no: 17136t.tif Safety function If the window glass encounters resistance above the middle of the window during automatic closing, it is immediately stopped and the window opened again. Child safety system for rear windows 3 Switch z between the rear switches in the driver’s door handle In the event of difficulty due to frost or the like, press the relevant window switch several times until the window is closed. z rearward (green field visible): rear door switches operational. z forward (red field visible): rear door switches non-operational, Picture no: 17976t.tif Central switch for electrically operated door windows, Astra TwinTop Button $ or " in the roof console. Press button $: all windows are closed. Press button $: all windows are opened. Windows, sunroof 143 Overload If the windows are repeatedly operated at short intervals, the power supply is briefly cut off. The system is protected by fuses in the fusebox – see page 261. Fault Automatic opening and closing of the windows is not possible. Activate window electronics as follows: 1. Close doors. 2. Switch on ignition. 3. Window completely open. 4. Close the window and hold the button depressed at least 5 seconds. 5. Repeat for each window. Picture no: 17046t.tif Operating windows from outside 3 The windows of vehicles with electrically operated windows in all doors 3 can also be opened or closed from outside using the remote control. Radio frequency remote control with mechanical key Hold down button q or p of the remote control until all the windows are open or fully closed. Picture no: 17034t.tif Open&Start system with electronic key 3 Hold down button q of remote control to open. To close, hold down button p or touch sensor in door handle for longer. The electronic key must be recognised within the external reception range. It is advisable for the driver to keep the electronic key on his person. 144 Windows, sunroof Picture no: 17140t.tif Panoramic windscreen 3 To open Turn the handle to the right and move the roof lining rearward to a suitable position. Picture no: 17141t.tif To close Move the roof lining forward to a suitable position. When moved all the way forward, the roof lining engages in position. Note Close the sunvisors before sliding the roof lining. Picture no: 17138t.tif Sunroof 3 Operated via rocker switches in the roof console when the ignition is switched on. For incremental operation, briefly press the button. For automatic opening or closing, press the button longer. Windows, sunroof 145 Note z If the top of the roof is wet, raise roof, allow water to run off and then open roof. To raise When the roof is closed, press button ü. The roof is tilted in the rear. To open Press button ü again from the tilted position. The roof opens to its stop. z When using a roof rack, check the clearance of the sunroof to avoid damage. To close Press button d. For reasons of safety, the roof closes from its open position to approx. 20 cm. Hold button d depressed to close the roof completely. Overload If the system is overloaded, the power supply is automatically cut off for a short time. Picture no: 17139t.tif The system is protected by fuses in the fusebox – see page 261. Sunblind Used to reduce sun penetration into the interior when the sunroof is closed. Fault If the sunroof and sunblind do not operate properly, activate electronics as follows: The sunblind opens when the sunroof opens. 1. Switch on ignition. To open Press button G. The sunblind opens to its stop. To close Press button H. For reasons of safety, the blind closes from its open position to approx. 20 cm. Hold button d depressed to close completely. 2. Close the sunroof and hold button d depressed at least 10 seconds. 3. Close sunblind and hold button H depressed at least 10 seconds. 146 TwinTop TwinTop With TwinTop, a convertible hardtop, Astra unites the benefits of a coupe with those of a convertible. 9 Warning Take care when operating the convertible hardtop. Risk of injury. Monitor the action zone above, to the side and to the rear of the vehicle during roof operation. Make sure that nothing could become pinched. TwinTop................................................ Wind deflector 3.................................. Rollover protection system ................. Luggage compartment....................... 146 149 151 152 Make sure no one is in the action zone of the roof or boot lid during roof operation. Risk of injury. Check the amount height, length and width of available space before operating the roof, e.g. in a garage, parking garage or when a bicycle rack is fitted. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. Before leaving the vehicle, remove the ignition key in order to prevent unauthorised operation of the windows and sunroof. Picture no: 18024T.tif TwinTop Operating the convertible hardtop Operational when the key is in position 1 in the starter switch. Requirements: z Vehicle is stationary or driving no more than 20 mph (30 km/h). z Luggage compartment blind is closed and engaged – see above and page 102. z Boot lid is closed. If any of the requirements are not fulfilled, a warning buzzer sounds when the switch is actuated and the roof does not open or close. TwinTop Picture no: 17962t.tif To open the roof There must be no objects in front of the rear window or in the pivot area of the roof and boot lid. Hold button > in the roof console depressed until the roof is completely open and the boot lid is closed. An acoustic signal sounds at the end of the opening procedure. Open the door windows slightly before opening the roof. If button > is pressed again after the acoustic signal sounds, the door windows will close. Picture no: 17970t.tif The roof can also be opened with the remote control when the vehicle is stationary. Unlock the vehicle. Press button q again and hold depressed until the roof is completely open and the boot lid is closed. During operation with the remote control, the door windows are opened completely. 147 Picture no: 17963t.tif To close the roof There must be no objects in the pivot area of the roof and boot lid. Hold button < in the roof console depressed until the roof and boot lid are completely closed. An acoustic signal sounds at the end of the closing procedure. Open the door windows slightly before closing the roof. If button < is pressed again after the acoustic signal sounds, the door windows will close. 6 148 TwinTop Indicator and warning buzzers z Indicator buzzer upon completed opening or closing of the convertible hardtop. z Indicator buzzer upon completed raising or lowering of the electric luggage compartment loading aid. z Gong tone if the boot lid is not closed during roof operation. z Gong tone if the boot lid is not fully opening during operation of the luggage compartment loading aid. Picture no: 17971t.tif The roof can also be closed with the remote control when the vehicle is stationary. Lock the vehicle. Press button p again and hold depressed until the roof and boot lid are completely closed. z Gong tone during roof operation if vehicle speed exceeds 20 mph (30 km/h). z Gong tone when vehicle speed exceeds 20 mph (30 km/h) if the roof is not fully open or closed. z Three gong tones during roof or loading aid operation if the luggage compartment blind is not attached. z Three gong tones during roof operation if outside temperature is below –20 °C, vehicle battery voltage is too low or the system is overloaded. z Continuous warning buzzer during roof operation if the anti-roll bars 3 have been triggered. z Continuous warning buzzer starting one minute before the end of the 9-minute standby time with the roof in an intermediate position. z Continuous warning buzzer starting one minute before the end of the 9-minute standby time with the loading aid in a raised position. TwinTop Note z Do not open the luggage compartment until the acoustic signal indicating the end of the roof opening or closing procedure has sounded. Fault The automatic drive of the roof is only operational if the roof is in the proper open or closed position. z The luggage compartment blind must always be closed during roof operation. z the luggage compartment blind is engaged in the closed position, z There must be no one at the covers behind the rear head restraints. z There must be no objects in the pivot area or the roof or on the covers behind the rear head restraints. z The roof can only be operated at temperatures above –20 °C. If the temperature is below this limit, a buzzer will sound three times when roof operation is requested. z The roof can be held in an intermediate position for 9 minutes to facilitate cleaning of roof spaces. This is done by disengaging the actuation switch. One minute before the end of this period, a continuous buzzer sounds as a warning that the hold period is almost over and the roof could start to move. z Operating the roof while travelling on uneven roads could lead to malfunction and damage. 149 Check if: z the boot lid is completely closed, z outside temperature is above –20 °C, z there is sufficient battery voltage, z there is a system overload. If the automatic drive is not operational, two persons are required to manually close the roof. See the accompanying instructions for Astra TwinTop. We recommend that you seek professional assistance. Picture no: 17964t.tif Wind deflector 3 With the wind deflector installed turbulence, draughts and noise in the passenger’s compartment are reduced when the roof is open. The rear seats cannot be occupied when the wind deflector is in place. Do not place any objects on the wind deflector. The wind deflector is folded together in a stowage compartment 3 in the luggage compartment beneath the floor hatch. If the vehicle is fitted with a spare wheel 3, the wind deflector is in the luggage compartment. 150 TwinTop Picture no: 17965t.tif Fitting Take the wind deflector from the luggage compartment. Expand the collapsed wind deflector as illustrated. Picture no: 17966t.tif Join together the unfolded ends of the wind deflector: press in the pin at the slider, guide the hinge over the pin and release the slider so that the pin engages in the hinge. Picture no: 17967t.tif Insert the guide clips of the wind deflector in the seat belt recesses between the rear head restraints. TwinTop 151 Rollover protection system To optimise safety in the event of a rollover, the Astra TwinTop is equipped with reinforced windscreen frame and anti-roll bars behind the rear seat head restraints. The anti-roll bars are fixed or deployable depending on model variant. 6 Picture no: 17968t.tif Pull the toggle of the right and left locking pin and turn to lock. Straighten out the wind deflector, turn the toggle back and engage the locking pin in the recess in the side trim. Picture no: 17969t.tif The wind deflector can be folded back when not in use. If the wind deflector is folded and the rear seats are unoccupied, the wind deflector can remain mounted in the vehicle when the roof is closed. Removing Reverse the procedure to remove. Stow the wind deflector in the luggage compartment. 152 TwinTop Picture no: 17975t.tif Fixed anti-roll bars are secured to the vehicle bodywork. Picture no: 17974t.tif Deployable anti-roll bars 3 are located between the rear head restraints and the boot lid in such a way that they are out of sight. In the event of a rollover, head-on collision or side-impact, the anti-roll bars deploy upwards within milliseconds. The convertible roof must not be operated if the anti-roll bars have been deployed. A continuous warning will sound if the switch is actuated. The airbag control indicator v illuminates if the anti-roll bars have been deployed. Manual retraction of the anti-roll bars – see page 130. Further information – see page 131. Picture no: 17973t.tif Luggage compartment The roof can only be opened if the load in the luggage compartment does not exceed the height of the luggage compartment blind. The marked load height (see illustration above) must not be exceeded and it must be possible for the blind to close flat. Otherwise, the roof or load could be damaged when the roof is opened. Electrically operated loading aid for the luggage compartment – see page 103. Luggage compartment blind – see page 102. Climate control 153 Climate control Air vents ............................................... Cooled glove compartment 3 ............ Heated rear window, heated exterior mirrors 3 ................. Heated front seats 3........................... Heating and ventilation system ......... Air conditioning system 3................... Automatic air conditioning system 3 Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 .... Air intake .............................................. Pollen filter ........................................... Note ...................................................... Maintenance ........................................ 155 155 156 156 157 160 162 167 173 173 173 173 Picture no: 17930t.tif Heating and ventilation system, air conditioning system 3 Ventilation, heating and cooling 3 are combined into one unit that is designed to provide comfort regardless of the season, weather or outside temperature. When cooling 3 is activated, the air is cooled and dried. The heating unit heats the air as required in all operating modes depending on the position of the temperature switch. The air supply can be adjusted to suit requirements by means of the fan. Picture no: 17142t.tif The buttons for cooling n and air recirculation 4 are only found on model variants with an air conditioning system 3. Air conditioning system 3 – see pages 160, 162. 154 Climate control The set values appear on the information display. Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 – see page 167. Picture no: 17931t.tif Automatic air conditioning system 3 Provides a comfortable interior regardless of the weather, outside temperature or season. When an interior temperature is set with the temperature control, the temperature and amount of inflowing air are automatically regulated. A uniform, comfortable climate in the vehicle is thereby automatically obtained based on outside climate conditions. Automatic air conditioning system – see page 162. Picture no: 17143t.tif Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 Offers the greatest comfort in the vehicle interior regardless of the conditions outside. To ensure a uniform and comfortable climate in the vehicle, the temperature of inflowing air, airflow rate and air distribution are automatically adapted based on the climate conditions outside the vehicle and the current temperature of the vehicle interior. Climate control Picture no: 17151t.tif Air vents Picture no: 17152t.tif Pleasant ventilation to the head area controlled by the position of the temperature switch. To close the vent, turn the vertical adjuster wheel fully up. The symbol 0 appears. The slats of the vent remain open although the air supply is closed. Centre and side air vents (1) Vents open: vertical knurled wheel down. Adjust the flow of air by turning the horizontal knurled wheel. Windscreen defroster nozzles (2) Air distribution switch to l or J: air flows onto windscreen and side windows. Additional vents below the windscreen and door windows and in the front footwell. Picture no: 17171t.tif Cooled glove compartment 3 Cooled air is fed into the glove compartment through a nozzle. If glove compartment cooling is not required, slide the slider forward. 155 156 Climate control General information, as well as information on air intake, air outlet, pollen filter and maintenance, see page 173 Picture no: 17147t.tif Picture no: 17148t.tif Heated rear window, heated exterior mirrors 3 Heated front seats 3 Operation with ignition switched on: Press switch ß one or more times to set the desired heat output. The control indicator in the switch indicates which of the three heating levels is active. On Off = = Press Ü Press Ü again Control indicator in pushbutton. Heating works with the engine running and is switched off automatically after around 15 minutes. Astra TwinTop: The headed rear window and heated exterior mirrors 3 are deactivated when the roof is open. Vehicles with diesel particle filter 3: the heated rear window is automatically switched on during particle filter cleaning. Operation with ignition switched on: We do not recommend prolonged use of the highest level for people with sensitive skin. Deactivation: press switch ß repeatedly until the control indicator goes out. Front seat heating is operational when the engine is running. Climate control Picture no: 17144t.tif Heating and ventilation system Left-hand rotary knob: Air distribution L to head area via adjustable air vents and to footwell M to head area via adjustable air vents l To the windscreen and front door windows J to the windscreen, front door windows, to footwell K to footwell Open the air vents when the switch is set to L or M. Picture no: 17145t.tif Centre rotary knob: Temperature Turn right = warm Turn left = cold 157 Picture no: 17146t.tif Right-hand rotary knob: Airflow Four fan speeds: x = off 4 = maximum airflow The rate of airflow is determined by the fan. The fan should therefore also be switched on during a journey. 158 Climate control Heating The amount of heat is dependent on the coolant temperature and is thus not fully attained until the engine is warm. The comfort and general well-being of the vehicle occupants are to a large extent dependent on a suitable ventilation and heating setting. For rapid warming of the passenger’s compartment: z Open air vents. To obtain a temperature distribution for a "cool head and warm feet", set the rotary knob for air distribution to K or J and set the temperature switch in the middle. z Set the air distribution switch to the desired position – see page 157. z Turn the temperature switch clockwise as far as it will go. Picture no: 17153t.tif Ventilation z For maximum ventilation to the head area: set air distribution switch to M, open all air vents, open slats of upper and centre air vents all the way see page 155. z For ventilation to footwell: set air distribution switch to K. z For simultaneous ventilation to the head area and the footwell: set air distribution switch to L. z Set the temperature to the desired setting. z Set the fan to the desired setting. z Activate fan speed three. For vehicles with Quickheat 3, electrical auxiliary heating warms up the passenger’s compartment more quickly. Climate control 159 z Set fan to 3 or 4. z Open side air vents as required and direct them towards door windows. z Switch on heated rear window Ü. For simultaneous warming of the footwell, set air distribution switch to J. Picture no: 17154t.tif Heating the footwell z Set air distribution switch to K. z Set the temperature switch in the right-hand zone. z Switch on fan. Picture no: 17155t.tif Demisting and defrosting windows 9 Warning Failure to follow the instructions could lead to misted or icy windows and accidents stemming from impaired visibility. Misted or icy windows, e. g. due to damp weather, damp clothing or low outside temperatures: z Move air distribution switch to l. z Turn the temperature switch clockwise as far as it will go (warm). 160 Climate control Air conditioning system 3 As a supplement to the heating and ventilation system, the air conditioning system cools and dehumidifies (dries) inflowing air. If cooling or dehumidification is not desired, switch off cooling in order to save fuel. Cooling switches off automatically at low outside temperatures. Picture no: 17149t.tif Cooling n Operate only with the engine on and the fan running: On = Press n Off = Press n again Control indicator in pushbutton. Picture no: 17150t.tif Air recirculation system 4 The recirculation switch 4 is used to set the ventilation system in recirculation mode (control indicator). If fumes or unpleasant odours penetrate from outside: temporarily switch on air recirculation system 4. Climate control 161 The air recirculation system minimises the entry of outside air. The humidity increases, and the windows can mist up. The quality of the passenger’s compartment air deteriorates which may cause the vehicle occupants to feel drowsy. Air distribution to l: the air recirculation system is automatically switched off to speed up window demisting and prevent fogging. Picture no: 17156t.tif Comfort setting z Set cooling n as desired. z Air recirculation system 4 off. z Set air distribution switch to M or L. z Set temperature switch as desired. z Switch on fan at desired speed. z Open vents as required. Temperature switch in centre of adjustment range: warmer air will flow into the footwell and cooler air into the upper zone, with warmer air coming from the side air vents and cooler air from the centre vents. Picture no: 17157t.tif Maximum cooling Open windows and sunroof 3 briefly so that warm air can escape rapidly. z Cooling n on. z Activate recirculation system 4. z Set air distribution switch to M. z Turn the temperature switch anticlockwise as far as it will go (cold). z Set fan to 4. z Open all vents. 162 Climate control z Cooling n on. z Move air distribution switch to l. z Turn the temperature switch clockwise. z Set fan to 4. z Open side air vents as required and direct them towards door windows. z Switch on heated rear window Ü. Picture no: 17158t.tif Window demisting and de-icing 9 Warning Failure to follow the instructions could lead to misted or icy windows and accidents stemming from impaired visibility. Misted or icy windows, e. g. due to damp weather, damp clothing or low outside temperatures: Automatic air conditioning system 3 Provides a uniformly comfortable interior regardless of the weather, outside temperature or season. To ensure a constant and comfortable climate in the vehicle, the temperature of the inflowing air and the airflow rate are changed automatically based on climate conditions outside the vehicle. Temperature changes due to external influences, such as direct sunlight, are automatically compensated. Climate control Picture no: 17932t.tif Automatic mode Basic setting for maximum comfort: z Set fan switch to A. Picture no: 17933t.tif Air distribution setting L to head area via adjustable air vents and to footwell 163 Picture no: 17934t.tif Temperature preset Set the rotary knob to a value between 17 °C and 27 °C. Intermediate settings are possible. M to head area via adjustable air vents l to the windscreen and front door windows For reasons of comfort, temperature can only be changed in small increments. J to the windscreen, front door windows, to footwell z All front air vents open. If desired, the rear vents also 3. K to footwell There is no temperature control for settings below 17 °C (all the way left) or above 27 °C (all the way right). The air conditioning system works at maximum cooling or heating. Deactivation of the air conditioning compressor can reduce the level of comfort and safety – see page 164. Open the air vents when the switch is set to L or M. z Set air distribution switch to desired position - see next column. z Use rotary knob to set temperature to 22 °C (a higher or lower temperature can be set as desired). z Air conditioning compressor activation – see page 164. Intermediate settings are possible. The selected temperature is maintained. 164 Climate control Picture no: 17935t.tif Airflow setting 1 - 4 Manual fan speed setting. Intermediate settings are possible. A Automatic control of fan speed. x Fan off. Fan speed is regulated to provide the rate of airflow necessary to maintain the preselected temperature. Picture no: 17936t.tif Picture no: 17937t.tif To activate / deactivate air conditioning compressor (cooling) n Operate only with the engine on and the fan running: On = Press n Off = Press n again Manual air recirculation mode The air recirculation system prevents the entry of outside air and the air in the passenger’s compartment is circulated. Control indicator in the switch illuminates. The exchange of fresh air is reduced in air recirculation mode. The quality of the passenger’s compartment air deteriorates which may cause the vehicle occupants to feel drowsy. In operation without cooling the air humidity increases, so the windows may mist up. Consequently, manual air recirculation should only be run for short periods of time. Select automatic mode for the highest level of comfort. When cooling (AC compressor) is active, air is cooled and dehumidified. If cooling or dehumidification is not desired, switch off cooling in order to save fuel. When the fan is off, the air conditioning compressor is also off. Cooling switches off automatically at low outside temperatures. Press button 4, the control indicator in the button will illuminate. To deactivate manual air recirculation: press button 4 again. The control indicator in the button will go out. Climate control Heating The amount of heat is dependent on the coolant temperature and is thus not fully attained until the engine is warm. For rapid warming of the passenger’s compartment: z Set the air distribution switch to the desired position – see page 157. z Set the centre rotary knob to the desired temperature. We recommend a value of about 22 °C. Picture no: 17938t.tif Ventilation z For maximum ventilation in head area: set air distribution switch to M and open all vents. z For ventilation to footwell: set air distribution switch to K. z For simultaneous ventilation to the head area and the footwell: set air distribution switch to L. z Set desired temperature. z Set fan switch to A. The fan can also be manually set: set the rotary knob to position 1 - 4. Intermediate settings are also possible. z Set fan switch to A. The fan can also be manually set: set the rotary knob to position 1 - 4. Intermediate settings are also possible. 165 For vehicles with Quickheat 3, electrical auxiliary heating warms up the passenger’s compartment more quickly. The comfort and general well-being of the vehicle occupants are to a large extent dependent on a suitable ventilation and heating setting. To obtain a stratification of temperature in the vehicle with the pleasant effect "cool head and warm feet", set the air distribution switch to K or J, set the temperature switch to about 22 °C and open the centre air vents. 166 Climate control z Set temperature to maximum heating, i.e. turn the centre rotary knob all the way to the right (28 °C). z Switch on heated rear window Ü. Operation with cooling (air conditioning compressor) is not possible when outside temperatures are low. To switch off, press button V again; the automatic air conditioning system will operate at the settings selected previously. Picture no: 17939t.tif Maximum cooling for very hot interior Open windows and sunroof 3 briefly so that warm air can escape rapidly. z Cooling n on. z Set air distribution switch to M. z Set the temperature switch to the desired temperature. z Set fan switch to A. z Open all vents. Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 provides maximum cooling down to the set value. At settings below 17 °C (rotary knob all the way to the left), the system continually runs with maximum cooling. When the air conditioning compressor is running, the system is automatically set to air recirculation. Picture no: 17940t.tif Window demisting and de-icing 9 Warning Failure to follow the instructions could lead to misted or icy windows and accidents stemming from impaired visibility. Misted or icy windows, e. g. due to damp weather, damp clothing or low outside temperatures: z Cooling n on. z Press button V: in switch position A, the fan automatically switches to the highest speed and air is directed to the windscreen. Climate control 167 Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 Provides the greatest amount of comfort in the interior regardless of the weather, outside temperature or season. To ensure a constant and comfortable climate in the vehicle, the temperature of the inflowing air, the airflow rate and the air distribution are changed automatically according to climatic conditions outside the vehicle. Temperature changes due to external influences, such as direct sunlight, are automatically compensated. Data is shown on the information display. Setting modifications are briefly shown in the information display, superimposing over the currently displayed menu. The display can vary according to the type of presentation – see page 46. The settings of the system are automatically stored specifically for the vehicle key used - see page 68. Different settings are stored for each remote control. Use of a remote control will activate the settings associated with it. Picture no: 17143t.tif Manual settings e.g. operating without cooling and air distribution can be selected using the menu – see page 169. When cooling (air conditioning compressor) is active, air is cooled and dehumidified. The pollen filter removes dust, soot, pollen and spores from the inflowing outside air. Picture no: 17160t.tif The automatic air recirculation system 3 has an air quality sensor 3 to detect harmful ambient gases, in which case it will switch automatically to recirculation. When set to automatic mode, the system provides the optimal settings for almost all conditions. If necessary, system settings can be modified manually. The system is only operational when the engine is running. Cooling (air conditioning compressor) switches off automatically at low outside temperatures. 168 Climate control Picture no: 17000t.tif Automatic mode Basic setting for maximum comfort: z Press AUTO button. z Open all air vents. z Air conditioning compressor activation – see page 170. z Set pre-selected temperature to 22 °C using left rotary knob. The temperature can be set higher or lower as desired. Switching off the AC compressor (Eco appears in display) can reduce comfort and affect safety – see page 170. Automatic air recirculation mode 3 The ventilation system is set to recirculation mode and interior air is recirculated. All air vents are actuated automatically in automatic mode. The air vents should therefore always be open – see page 155. The automatic air recirculation system has an air quality sensor to detect harmful gases in the outside air, in which case it will switch automatically to recirculation. If outside temperatures are low and cooling (air conditioning compressor) is switched off, automatic air recirculation is only available in a limited capacity so as to prevent the windows from misting. Activate recirculation manually if so desired. Switching automatic recirculation on or off – see page 172. Manual recirculation mode – see page 172. Climate control Temperature preset The left rotary knob can be used to set temperatures between 16 °C and 28 °C. For reasons of comfort, temperature can only be changed in small increments. Climate Air distribut. AC 169 Air distribut. Autom. blower Auto. recirc For vehicles with Quickheat 3, electrical heating warms up the passenger’s compartment more quickly. If a temperature below 16 °C is set, Lo appears in the display: the system runs constantly at maximum cooling power. The temperature is not regulated. If a temperature above 28 °C is set, Hi appears in the display: the system runs constantly at maximum heating power. The temperature is not regulated. Temperature settings are stored when the ignition is switched off. Picture no: 17161t.tif Picture no: 17162t.tif Manual settings Under certain circumstances (e.g. iced or misted windows), the functions of the system can be modified manually. Individual menu items are marked by turning the centre knob and selected by pressing it. Selecting certain menus by pressing the knob will open a submenu 3. System settings can be changed via the centre knob, the buttons and the menus depicted on the display. To exit a menu, turn the centre knob left or right to Return or Main and select. Press the centre knob to call up the menu. The menu for manual system settings appears in the display. Manual settings are stored when the ignition is switched off. 170 Climate control The airflow can be increased or decreased by turning the right knob. To return to automatic mode: press button V or AUTO. Heated rear window – see page 156. Picture no: 17163t.tif Window demisting and de-icing 9 Warning Failure to follow the instructions could lead to misted or icy windows and accidents stemming from impaired visibility. Misted or icy windows, e.g. due to damp weather, damp clothing or low outside temperatures: Press V button. V appears in display: control indicator in button illuminates. The temperature and the air distribution are adjusted automatically, the fan runs at a faster speed and the windows are rapidly cleared of ice and moisture. Climate Air distribut. AC Autom. blower Auto. recirc Air conditioning on / off Picture no: 17164t.tif Activating and deactivating air conditioning compressor If no cooling or dehumidification is required, switch the air conditioning compressor off (maximum energy savings): mark menu item AC from the manual settings menu and select by pressing. Eco appears on the display. Inflowing air is neither cooled nor dehumidified. This restricts the level of comfort provided by the Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3. This may cause the windows to mist up, for example. To activate cooling: select menu item AC from the manual settings menu and press to activate cooling. Climate control Air distribut. 171 Automatic blower Strong Normal Weak Picture no: 17165t.tif Picture no: 17166t.tif Air distribution Press the centre knob. The possible air distribution settings appear one after another in the display. Airflow Turn right-hand knob right or left. The selected fan speed in indicated with x and the number in the display. Air distribution can also be set in the Air distribut. menu: At speed 0 both the fan and cooling (air conditioning compressor) are switched off. Up Air distribution to windscreen and front door windows To return to automatic mode: press AUTO button. Centre Air to vehicle occupants via front adjustable air vents Down Air distribution to footwell Return to automatic air distribution: deactivate corresponding setting or press AUTO button. Picture no: 17167t.tif Fan control in automatic mode 3 Fan regulation in automatic mode can be modified. Select menu item Automatic blower from the manual settings menu and select the desired fan control. Depending on the setting, the maximum airflow, and thereby the noise level, will increase. 172 Climate control Climate Air distribut. AC Autom. blower Auto. recirc Automatic recirculation air control at bad outside air Picture no: 17168t.tif Residual air conditioning on Picture no: 17169t.tif Switching automatic recirculation 3 on or off The automatic air recirculation system has an air quality sensor to detect harmful gases in the outside air, in which case it will switch automatically to recirculation. Manual air recirculation mode The air recirculation system prevents the entry of outside air and the air in the passenger’s compartment is circulated. Select menu item Auto. recirc from the manual settings menu and switch it on or off by pressing. The exchange of fresh air is reduced in air recirculation mode. The quality of the passenger’s compartment air deteriorates which may cause the vehicle occupants to feel drowsy. In operation without cooling the air humidity increases, so the windows may mist up. Consequently, manual air recirculation should only be run for short periods of time. Switch to manual air recirculation as necessary. Press button 4, the control indicator in the button will illuminate. To deactivate manual air recirculation: press button 4 again. The control indicator in the button will go out. Picture no: 17170t.tif Air conditioning with the engine not running When the vehicle is stopped and the ignition off, the heat or cooling power still in the system can be used to condition the passenger’s compartment, for example when stopped at a level crossing. Press AUTO button with the ignition off. Residual air conditioning on will appear briefly in the display. The air conditioning will operate for a limited period of time. To cancel air conditioning, press the AUTO button. Climate control Note If the windscreen mists up in damp weather, temporarily set the system as described under "Window demisting" – see page 159, 162 or 170. Cooling 3 is most efficient when the windows are closed. If the interior is extremely hot due to a long period in strong sunlight, briefly open the windows and sunroof 3 to allow the hot air to escape quickly. Picture no: 17438t.tif Air intake The air intakes in front of the windscreen in the engine compartment must be kept clear to allow air intake. Remove any leaves, dirt or snow. Pollen filter The pollen filter cleans dust, soot, pollen and spores from the air entering from outside. The active carbon layer 3 eliminates most odours and harmful ambient gases from the air. Replace the pollen filter at the intervals given in the Service Booklet. When cooling 3 (air conditioning compressor) is switched on condensation forms, which is expelled from the underside of the vehicle. At least one air vent must be open while cooling 3 (air conditioning compressor) is on in order to prevent the evaporator from icing up due to lack of air movement. Cooling switches off automatically at low outside temperatures. Do not cover the sensor on the instrument panel as this could cause the Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 to malfunction. 173 Maintenance In order to ensure continuously efficient performance, the air conditioning compressor 3 must be operated for a few minutes once a month, irrespective of the weather and time of year. The Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3, if present, handles this automatically while driving. Air conditioning compressor operation is not possible when outside temperatures are low. If a fault occurs, consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 174 Easytronic Easytronic The semi-automatic Easytronic transmission 3 permits manual (manual mode) or automatic gearshifting (automatic mode), both with automatic clutch control. 9 Warning Transmission display ........................... Starting the engine.............................. Easytronic operation via the selector lever ............................... Move selector lever toward N............. Starting-off........................................... Electronically controlled driving programmes ...................................... Winter programme T ......................... Kickdown .............................................. Braking assistance from engine ......... Stopping the vehicle............................ Vehicle storage .................................... "Rocking the car" ................................. Manoeuvring the vehicle..................... Fault...................................................... Interruption of power supply .............. 174 174 175 175 175 176 177 178 178 178 179 179 179 180 180 Disregard of these instructions may lead to injuries or endanger life. Picture no: 17173t.tif Transmission display Shows the mode and current gear. Starting the engine The engine can only be started when the foot brake is depressed. "N" is shown in the transmission display and flashes if the foot brake is not depressed. It is not necessary to select the neutral position before starting. If no gear is engaged, the transmission automatically shifts into neutral position (N) before starting the engine. This can lead to a slight delay when starting. Easytronic 175 It is also possible to start off without depressing the foot brake if the accelerator pedal is operated directly after movement of the selector lever. If there is no immediate acceleration or the foot brake is not depressed, no gear is engaged and "A" flashes. After a few seconds, the display resumes showing "N". Start off by repeating the previously described procedure. In Automatic mode, selection of other gears is automatic irrespective of driving conditions. Picture no: 17002t.tif Picture no: 17174t.tif Always move the selector lever in the appropriate direction as far as it will go. Upon release, it automatically returns to the centre position. Pay heed to the gear / mode indicator in the transmission display. Starting-off Depress the foot brake, release the handbrake and move the selector lever to A, + or -. Easytronic is in automatic mode and first gear is engaged (second gear if the Winter programme is active). "A1" appears in the transmission display ("A2" if the Winter programme is active). Move selector lever toward N Neutral. The vehicle begins to "creep" when the foot brake is released. Easytronic operation via the selector lever Move selector lever toward A Switch between Automatic and Manual mode. Manual gearshifting is possible in manual mode. "M" and the currently engaged gear appear in the transmission display. If the engine speed is too low the Easytronic will automatically shift to a lower gear even in Manual mode. This prevents the engine from stalling. 176 Easytronic If the vehicle is in automatic mode, on movement of the selector lever to + or Easytronic shifts to manual mode and changes up or down. "M" and the currently engaged gear appear in the transmission display. Move selector lever toward R Reverse gear. Engage only when vehicle is stationary. Picture no: 17002t.tif Move selector lever toward + or + Shift to a higher gear. - Shift to a lower gear. If a higher gear is selected when the running speed is too low, or a lower gear when the speed is too high, no shift is effected. This prevents the engine from running at too low or too high revs. Gears can be skipped by moving the selector lever repeatedly at short intervals. Depress the foot brake, release the handbrake and move the selector lever to R. Reverse gear is engaged. "R" appears in the transmission display. The vehicle begins to "creep" when the foot brake is released. It is also possible to start off in reverse without depressing the foot brake if the accelerator pedal is operated directly after movement of the selector lever. If there is no immediate acceleration or the foot brake is not depressed, no gear is engaged and "R" flashes. After a few seconds, the display resumes showing "N". Start off by repeating the previously described procedure. Electronically controlled driving programmes z By means of delayed gear changing (higher engine speeds) following a cold start, the operating temperature programme in automatic mode quickly and automatically brings the catalytic converter to the temperature required for optimum pollutant reduction. z Adaptive programmes automatically adapt gearshifting in automatic mode to suit the driving conditions, such as if the vehicle is towing a caravan / trailer, has a high payload, or is being driven on inclines. Easytronic 177 If the Winter programme is activated, SPORT mode is deactivated. If the vehicle is switched to manual mode while the winter programme is active, the winter programme is interrupted. The winter programme resumes upon return to automatic mode. Picture no: 17961t.tif z When SPORT mode is engaged, shift times are reduced and the transmission shifts at higher engine speeds (unless cruise control is on). SPORT mode – see page 210. z Winter programme: press button T – see next column. Picture no: 17175t.tif Winter programme T In the event of difficulties starting-off on slippery roads, press button T ("A", currently engaged gear and T appear in the transmission display). Easytronic switches to automatic mode and the vehicle sets off in second gear. The winter programme is switched off by: z pressing button T again, z turning off the ignition. In order to protect the Easytronic the winter programme automatically switches itself off at extremely high clutch temperatures. 178 Easytronic When the engine speed approaches its upper limit, the transmission shifts to a higher gear during kickdown even in Manual mode. Without kickdown this automatic shift is not effected in Manual mode. If SPORT mode is engaged, the drive wheels may spin slightly when starting-off with kickdown. This allows for maximum acceleration of the vehicle. Braking assistance from engine Picture no: 17176t.tif Kickdown Accelerator pedal pressed past the pressure point: below certain speeds, the transmission shifts down into a lower gear. Full engine power is available for acceleration. During kickdown no manual gearshifting is possible. Automatic mode When driving downhill, Easytronic does not shift into higher gears until a fairly high engine speed has been reached. When braking, Easytronic shifts down in good time. Manual mode To utilise the engine braking effect, select a lower gear in good time when driving downhill. Stopping the vehicle In Automatic or Manual mode, when the vehicle has stopped first gear (with Winter mode engaged, second gear) is engaged automatically and the clutch released. In R reverse remains engaged. A warning buzzer sounds when the driver’s door is opened if the engine is running, a gear is engaged and the foot brake is not depressed. The vehicle creeps if the handbrake is not engaged. Move the selector lever to N and apply the handbrake. When stopping on gradients, engage the handbrake or depress the brake pedal. To prevent overheating of the clutch, do not increase engine speed to ensure smooth idling when in gear. The clutch is automatically closed in the event of overheating. Switch off engine if stopping for a lengthy period, e.g. in traffic jams or at level crossings. Easytronic Vehicle storage "Rocking the car" Before leaving the vehicle: z engage handbrake, z remove the ignition key or, with the Open&Start system 3, remove the electronic key from the vehicle. If it becomes necessary to rock the vehicle to free it from sand, mud, snow or a hole, move the selector lever between R and A (or + or -) in a repeat pattern while applying light pressure to the accelerator pedal. Do not race the engine and avoid sudden acceleration. The most recently engaged gear (indicator in transmission display) remains engaged. With N, no gear is engaged. When the ignition is switched off the Easytronic no longer responds to movement of the selector lever. Lock the vehicle. Otherwise the battery may become discharged if the vehicle is parked for long periods. If the handbrake has not been applied, the control indicator R flashes for a few seconds after the ignition is switched off. With the engine off and the handbrake not applied, when the driver’s door is opened a warning buzzer sounds and the control indicator R flashes; switch on ignition, engage gear, switch off ignition and apply handbrake. 179 This applies only to the exceptional circumstances mentioned above. Picture no: 17177t.tif Manoeuvring the vehicle To manoeuvre the vehicle back and forth during attempts to park or in garage entrances the creeping movement can be utilised by releasing the foot brake. Never actuate accelerator and brake pedals simultaneously. To prevent damage, Easytronic disengages the "creep" function when the temperature of the automatic clutch is high. 180 Easytronic If F appears in the transmission display, continued driving is not possible. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. Fault Picture no: 17028t.tif Control indicator A illuminates in the event of a fault in the Easytronic system. In the event of serious faults, F also appears in the transmission display. It is possible to continue driving if only control indicator A illuminates. Manual mode can then no longer be selected. Picture no: 17178t.tif Interruption of power supply The clutch is not disengaged if the vehicle battery is discharged and a gear has been selected. The vehicle cannot move. If the battery is flat, start the vehicle using jump leads – see page 244. Easytronic If the interruption of power supply was not caused by a discharged battery, consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. If the vehicle must be moved out of the flow of traffic, disengage the clutch on vehicles with 5-speed Easytronic. Disengaging the clutch is not possible on vehicles with 6-speed Easytronic 3. The vehicle must be moved. Raise the vehicle by the front axle when towing. To disengage the clutch (only on vehicles with 5-speed Easytronic): 1. Apply handbrake and switch off ignition. 2. Open bonnet. 3. Clean Easytronic around the cap (see illustration) so that no dirt can get into the opening when the cap is removed. 4. Rotate cap to slacken and remove by lifting upwards – see illustration. 5. Turn the adjusting screw clockwise using a flat-head screwdriver (vehicle tools 3 – see page 251) until clear resistance can be felt. The clutch has now been disengaged. Do not turn beyond the resistance, since this can damage the Easytronic. 181 6. Fit cleaned cap again. The cap must be in full contact with the housing. Towing the vehicle and starting the engine is not permitted when the clutch has been released in this way, although the vehicle can be moved a short distance. Consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 182 Automatic transmission Automatic transmission Selector lever settings P, R, N and D (automatic mode) ............................. Gears 3, 2, 1 ......................................... Electronically controlled driving programmes ...................................... Winter programme T ......................... Kickdown .............................................. Engine braking..................................... "Rocking the car" ................................. Manoeuvring the vehicle..................... Stopping the vehicle............................ Fault...................................................... Interruption of power supply .............. The automatic transmission 3 makes automatic gearchanges possible (automatic mode). The engine can only be started when the gear selector is in position P or N. When starting in position N, depress the foot brake or apply the handbrake. After starting the engine, depress the brake before selecting a gear. Do not accelerate whilst selecting a gear. If a gear has been selected and the brake is released, the vehicle will "creep". Never operate the accelerator and the brake pedal simultaneously. The selected gear is displayed in the transmission display. 183 183 184 185 185 185 185 186 186 186 187 9 Warning Disregard of these instructions may lead to injuries or endanger life. Selecting D puts the transmission in automatic mode. Only select 3, 2 or 1 to prevent automatic upshifting or as an aid in engine braking. Picture no: 17022t.tif Transmission display Display of mode or selected gear in left position of transmission display. The gear that has been selected by the transmission appears in the right position of the transmission display. P Park position. R Reverse gear. N Neutral. D Automatic mode. 3, 2, 1 Selected gear 3. Automatic transmission The selector lever can only be moved from P when the ignition is switched on and the foot brake depressed (selector lever lock). To engage P or R, push button on selector lever. The engine can only be started with lever in position P or N. When position N is selected, press foot brake or engage handbrake before starting. Do not accelerate during the selection procedure. Picture no: 17189t.tif Selector lever settings P, R, N and D (automatic mode) P Park position. Front wheels locked. Only engage when the vehicle is stationary and the handbrake is applied. "P" on the transmission display. R Reverse gear. Only engage when the vehicle is stationary. "R" appears on the transmission display. N Neutral or idle. "N" appears on the transmission display. D Drive position for normal driving in 1st gear to highest gear. "D" and the current gear appear in the transmission display. Gears 3, 2, 1 3, 2, 1 Transmission does not shift above the selected gear. Press button on selector lever to engage 3 or 1. The current gear is displayed in the transmission display. 183 184 Automatic transmission z Automatic neutral shift function automatically sets the transmission to N to reduce fuel consumption, e.g. at traffic lights. The automatic neutral is activated when: – the selector lever is in automatic mode 3, – the selector lever is in position 3, 2 or 1, – the foot brake is depressed, – the vehicle is stationary, Picture no: 17961t.tif Electronically controlled driving programmes z When SPORT mode is engaged, the transmission shifts at higher engine speeds (unless cruise control is on). Control indicator 1 illuminates in the transmission display. SPORT mode – see page 210. z Winter programme: press button T – see next page. – the accelerator pedal is not actuated, – the transmission fluid temperature is greater than 0 °C. As soon as the brake is released and the accelerator pedal is depressed, the vehicle starts off in the usual manner. z By means of delayed gear changing (higher engine speeds) following a cold start, the operating temperature programme quickly and automatically brings the catalytic converter to the temperature required for optimum pollutant reduction. z The adaptive programme automatically tailors gearshifting to the driving conditions, e.g. greater load or gradients. Automatic transmission 185 Engine braking In order to utilise the engine braking effect when driving downhill, select drive range 3, 2 or, if necessary, 1 in good time. The braking action is most effective in drive range 1. If drive range 1 is selected at too high a speed, the transmission remains in second gear until the shift point for first gear is reached, e.g. as a result of deceleration. "Rocking the car" Picture no: 17190t.tif Picture no: 17176t.tif Winter programme T Kickdown Press button T if you are having problems starting-off on a slippery road surface. Depressing the accelerator pedal past the pressure point: depending on the engine speed the transmission shifts to a lower gear. Full engine power is available for accelerating. To activate The winter programme can be activated in P, R, N, D and 3 (T illuminates in the transmission display). The vehicle starts off in 3rd gear. To deactivate The winter programme is switched off by: z pressing button T again, z shifting to 2 or 1 manually, z turning off the ignition. In order to prevent damage, the winter programme switches off automatically at high transmission oil temperatures. If it becomes necessary to rock the vehicle to free it from sand, mud, snow or a hole, move the selector lever from D to R in a repeat pattern while simultaneously applying light pressure to the accelerator pedal. Do not race the engine and avoid sudden acceleration. This applies only to the exceptional circumstances mentioned above. 186 Automatic transmission Stopping the vehicle The selector lever can be left in the chosen gear with the engine running. When stopping on gradients engage handbrake or depress brake pedal. To prevent overheating of the transmission, do not increase engine revolutions to ensure smooth idling while standing if a gear has been selected. Switch off engine if stopping for a lengthy period, e.g. in traffic jams or at level crossings. Picture no: 17177t.tif Manoeuvring the vehicle To manoeuvre the vehicle back and forth during attempts to park or in garage entrances, the vehicle’s creeping movement can be utilised by releasing the brake pedal. Never actuate accelerator and brake pedals simultaneously. Before leaving the vehicle, first apply the handbrake. Then select P. Remove the ignition key or, with Open&Start system, remove the electronic key 3 from the vehicle. Lock the vehicle. Otherwise the battery may become discharged if the vehicle is parked up for long periods. The ignition key can only be removed when the selector lever is in position P. With the Open&Start system 3, "P" flashes in the transmission display for 10 seconds when the ignition is switched off if P has not been engaged or the handbrake has not been applied. Fault Picture no: 17028t.tif Control indicator A illuminates after the ignition is switched on. If it does not go out after the start or illuminates while driving, there is a fault in the automatic transmission or engine electronics. Automatic transmission 187 The transmission no longer shifts automatically. Vehicle can continue to be driven. Second gear is not available. Forward gears 1, 3 and 4 must be shifted manually using selector lever: 1 = 2 = 3, D = 1st gear 3rd gear 4th gear Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17191t.tif Interruption of power supply Picture no: 17192t.tif If the vehicle battery is flat, the selector lever cannot be moved out of position P. 3. Push the yellow catch forward with a screwdriver and move the selector lever out of P. If the battery is flat, start the vehicle using jump leads – see page 244. 4. Mount selector lever trim on centre console and refit. If the battery is not the cause of the fault, release selector lever: Re-selecting P locks the selector lever again. Have cause of power supply interruption remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 1. Apply handbrake. 2. Disengage selector lever trim rearward from centre console and fold upwards. 188 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect Transmission display ........................... Selector lever settings P, R, N and D (automatic mode) ............................. ActiveSelect (manual mode) .............. Electronically controlled driving programmes ...................................... Winter programme T ......................... Kickdown .............................................. Engine braking..................................... "Rocking the car" ................................. Manoeuvring the vehicle..................... Stopping the vehicle............................ Fault...................................................... Interruption of power supply .............. This automatic transmission 3 allows both automatic gear changes (automatic mode) and manual gear changes (manual mode) 3. The engine can only be started when the selector lever is in position P or N. When starting in position N, depress the foot brake or apply the handbrake. After the engine has started, depress the brake before selecting a gear. Do not accelerate whilst selecting a gear. If a gear has been selected and the brake is released, the vehicle will "creep". Never operate the accelerator and the brake pedal simultaneously. The selected gear is displayed in the transmission display – see page 189. 189 189 190 191 192 192 193 193 193 194 194 195 9 Warning Disregard of these instructions may lead to injuries or endanger life. Selecting D puts the transmission in automatic mode. If the selector lever is moved to the left from the D position, manual mode is activated. Gear changes can then be made manually by tipping the selector lever toward + or -. Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect 189 The selector lever can only be moved out of position P or N with the ignition switched on and the foot brake applied (selector lever lock). In selector lever position N the selector lever lock is activated after a delay and only if the vehicle is stationary. Picture no: 17022t.tif Transmission display Display of mode or selected gear in left position of transmission display. The gear that has been selected by the transmission appears in the right position of the transmission display. Picture no: 17193t.tif Selector lever settings P, R, N and D (automatic mode) P Park position. Front wheels locked. Only engage when the vehicle is stationary and the handbrake is applied. "P" on the transmission display. R Reverse gear. Only engage when the vehicle is stationary. "R" appears on the transmission display. P Park position. R Reverse gear. N Neutral. D Automatic mode. N M Manual mode with display of selected gear. Neutral or idle. "N" appears on the transmission display. D Drive position for normal driving in 1st gear to highest gear. "D" and the current gear appear in the transmission display. 190 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect If the engine revs are too low the transmission automatically shifts to a lower gear, but not unless a certain speed has been reached. No automatic shifting to a higher gear takes place at high engine revs. For safety reasons, kickdown is also available in manual mode – see page 192. The selected gear is displayed in the transmission display – see page 189. Picture no: 17194t.tif In position P or N, control indicator j illuminates red in the selector lever indicator strip if the selector lever is blocked. To engage P or R, push button on selector lever. The engine can only be started with lever in position P or N. When position N is selected, press foot brake or engage handbrake before starting. Do not accelerate during the selection procedure. Picture no: 17195t.tif ActiveSelect (manual mode) Move selector lever out of position D and then forwards or backwards. + - Shift to a higher gear Shift to a lower gear If a higher gear is selected at a speed that is too slow or a lower gear is selected at a speed that is too high, the gear will not be changed. This prevents the revs from being too low or too high. Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect z Automatic neutral shift function automatically sets the transmission to N to reduce fuel consumption, e.g. at traffic lights. The automatic neutral is activated when: – the selector lever is in automatic or manual mode, – the foot brake is depressed, – the vehicle is stationary, – the accelerator pedal is not actuated, Picture no: 17961t.tif Electronically controlled driving programmes z When SPORT mode is engaged, the transmission shifts at higher engine speeds (unless cruise control is on). Control indicator 1 illuminates in the transmission display. SPORT mode – see page 210. z Winter programme: press button T – see next page. – the transmission fluid temperature is greater than 0 °C. As soon as the brake is released and the accelerator pedal is depressed, the vehicle starts off in the usual manner. 191 z The operating temperature programme automatically brings the catalytic converter to the temperature that is required for optimum emission reduction after a cold start by selecting an appropriate gear (increased engine revs). z The adaptive programme automatically tailors gearshifting to the driving conditions, e.g. greater load or gradients. 192 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect To deactivate The winter programme is switched off by: z pressing button T again, z changing to manual mode, z turning off the ignition. In order to prevent damage, the winter programme switches off automatically at high transmission oil temperatures. Picture no: 17196t.tif Picture no: 17176t.tif Winter programme T Kickdown Press button T if you are having problems starting-off on a slippery road surface. Depressing the accelerator pedal past the pressure point: depending on the engine speed, the transmission shifts to a lower gear. Full engine power is available for accelerating. To activate The winter programme can be activated in automatic mode (T illuminates in transmission display). The vehicle starts off in 4th gear. For safety reasons, kickdown is available in both automatic and manual mode. Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect Engine braking "Rocking the car" The automatic transmission automatically selects the driving programmes with the best possible braking effect. If it becomes necessary to rock the vehicle to free it from sand, mud, snow or a hole, move the selector lever from D to R in a repeat pattern while simultaneously applying light pressure to the accelerator pedal. Do not race the engine and avoid sudden acceleration. If necessary, lower gears can also be selected in manual mode to increase the braking effect. 1st gear has the greatest braking effect. 193 This applies only to the exceptional circumstances mentioned above. Picture no: 17177t.tif Manoeuvring the vehicle To manoeuvre the vehicle back and forth during attempts to park or in garage entrances, the vehicle’s creeping movement can be utilised by releasing the brake pedal. Never actuate accelerator and brake pedals simultaneously. 194 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect Stopping the vehicle The selector lever can be left in the chosen gear with the engine running. When stopping on gradients engage handbrake or depress brake pedal. To prevent overheating of the transmission, do not increase engine revolutions to ensure smooth idling while standing if a gear has been selected. Switch off engine if stopping for a lengthy period, e.g. in traffic jams or at level crossings. Before leaving the vehicle, first apply the handbrake. Then select P. Remove the ignition key or, with Open&Start system, remove the electronic key 3 from the vehicle. Lock the vehicle. Otherwise the battery may become discharged if the vehicle is parked up for long periods. The ignition key can only be removed when the selector lever is in position P. If the selector lever is not in position P when the ignition is switched off, control indicator j and P flash in the selector lever indicator strip – see page 190, Fig. S 12103. Move the selector lever to position P. With the Open&Start system 3, "P" flashes in the transmission display for 10 seconds when the ignition is switched off if P has not been engaged or the handbrake has not been applied. Fault Picture no: 17028t.tif If there is a problem with the automatic transmission, control indicator A illuminates. The transmission no longer shifts automatically. The vehicle can continue to be driven. Illumination of control indicator A may also indicate a problem with the engine electronics – see page 206. For diesel engines1) Z 19 DT and Z 19 DTH, illumination of control indicator A could also indicate that the diesel fuel filter must be drained of water – see page 294. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 1) Sales designation – see page 309. Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect 195 2nd gear and the highest gear can be selected in manual mode. Depending on the nature of the problem, only the highest gear may be available. Only the highest gear is available in D in automatic mode. Picture no: 17097t.tif Interruption of power supply If the vehicle battery is flat, the selector lever cannot be moved out of position P or N. If the battery is flat, start the vehicle using jump leads – see page 244. If the battery is not the cause of the fault, release selector lever: 1. Apply handbrake. 2. Remove the ashtray insert 3 or the rubber covering on the bottom of the stowage compartment 3 – see page 106. Picture no: 17856t.tif 3. To open, push the yellow catch down with a screwdriver and move the selector lever out of P or N. 4. Refit the ashtray insert 3 or rubber covering on the bottom of the stowage compartment 3 – see page 106. Re-selecting P or N locks the selector lever again. Have cause of power supply interruption remedied. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 196 Driving hints Driving hints The first 600 miles (1000 km) Drive your vehicle at various speeds. Do not use full throttle. Never allow the engine to labour at low revs. Make good use of all gears. Depress the accelerator pedal a maximum of around three quarters of the available pedal travel in all gears. Do not drive faster than three quarters of maximum speed. Do not brake unnecessarily hard for the first 125 miles (200 km). Never coast with engine not running Many units will not function in this situation (e.g. brake servo unit, Electro-Hydraulic Power-assisted Steering (EHPS)). Driving in this manner is a danger to yourself and others. Brake servo unit When the engine is not running, the brake servo unit is no longer effective once the brake pedal has been depressed once or twice. Braking effect is not reduced, but significantly greater force is required for braking. Electro-Hydraulic Power-assisted Steering (EHPS) If the power-assisted steering fails when being towed with the engine switched off, the vehicle can still be steered, but considerably more force is required. Driving in mountainous terrain or with a caravan / trailer The cooling fan is electrically operated. Its cooling power is therefore independent of the engine speed. Since a considerable amount of heat is generated at high engine speeds and less at slower speeds, do not shift down when climbing hills whilst the vehicle is still coping with the gradient in the higher gear. Driving with a roof load Do not exceed the permissible roof load – see pages 234, 318. For reasons of safety, distribute the load evenly and secure it properly with retaining straps. Adjust the tyre pressure to the load conditions. Do not drive faster than 75 mph (120 km/h). Check and re-tighten the straps frequently. Observe country-specific regulations. Roof loads are not permitted on the Astra TwinTop. Switching off the engine When you switch off, fans in the engine compartment may continue running for a time to cool the engine. If the engine temperature is very high, e.g. after driving in mountainous terrain: allow the engine to idle for approximately two minutes in order to prevent heat accumulation. Driving hints Vehicles with turbocharged engine After running at high engine speeds or high engine loads, operate the engine briefly at a low load or run in neutral for approx. 30 seconds before switching off in order to protect the turbocharger. Save energy – more miles Please observe the running-in hints on the previous page and the tips for saving energy on the following pages. Good, technically correct and economical driving ensures maximum durability and performance for your vehicle. Overrun The fuel supply is automatically shut off during overrun, e.g. when the vehicle is being driven down long gradients or when braking. To enable the overrun cut-off to take effect, do not accelerate during overrun and, if in manual transmission mode, do not declutch. To prevent damage to the catalytic converter, overrun cut-off is temporarily deactivated when the catalytic converter temperature is high. Vehicles with turbocharged engine Flow-generated noises may be audible if the accelerator is released quickly on account of airflow in the turbocharger. 197 Engine speed Cooling fan Drive in a low engine speed range for each gear as much as possible. The cooling fan is controlled via a thermoswitch and therefore only runs if necessary. Warming up After a cold start, the automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3 in automatic mode shifts into higher gears at higher rpm. This allows the catalytic converter to quickly reach the temperature required for optimum pollutant reduction. Correct gear selection Engine in neutral and without revving in the lower gears. Stop-and-go traffic and driving at a speed too high for the selected gear or transmission ratio increases wear and fuel consumption. Change down When decreasing speed, shift down into the next lowest gear. Do not slip the clutch with a high-revving engine. This is especially important when hill climbing. Clutch operation Always depress the clutch pedal hard to the floor to prevent shifting difficulties and transmission damage. When driving do not use the pedal as a footrest; this will cause substantial clutch wear. Vehicles with diesel particle filter 3: the cooling fan comes on automatically during particle filter cleaning. Pedals Do not place any objects in the footwell which could slip under the pedals and inhibit the pedal travel. To ensure the pedal travel is uninhibited, there must be no mats in the area of the pedals. Battery care When driving slowly or when the vehicle is stationary, e.g. in slow urban traffic, stopand-go traffic or traffic jams, turn off all unnecessary electrical loads where possible (e.g. heated rear window, heated front seats). Declutch when starting in order to relieve the strain on the starter and the battery. 198 Saving fuel, protecting the environment Saving fuel, protecting the environment New painting techniques employ water as a solvent. End-of-life vehicle recovery For detailed information on Vauxhall’s on-going commitment to achieving an environmentally sustainable future, including; design for recycling, take back of End-of-Life Vehicle (ELVs) and the recycling of ELVs, view www.vauxhall.co.uk/recycling for details. Energy and environment – conscious driving Trend-setting technology When developing and manufacturing your vehicle, Vauxhall used environmentfriendly and in the main recyclable materials. The production methods used to make your vehicle are likewise environmentally-compatible. Recycling of production wastes keeps the circulation of material closed. Reduction of energy and water requirements also helps to conserve natural resources. A highly advanced design means that your vehicle can be easily disassembled at the end of its working life, and the individual materials separated for subsequent re-use. Materials such as asbestos and cadmium are not used. The refrigerant in the air conditioning system 3 is CFC-free. z High noise levels and exhaust emissions are often a result of driving without due attention to saving energy and protecting the environment. z You should therefore drive with energy in mind – "more miles with less fuel". Reduce the noise level and exhaust emissions by adopting an environmentconscious driving style. This is extremely worthwhile and improves the quality of life. Fuel consumption depends to a great extent on your own personal driving style. The following hints are intended to help you consume fuel at a rate that is as close as possible to the specified levels – see page 313. Check your vehicle’s fuel consumption every time you refuel. This facilitates early detection of any irregularities causing increased fuel consumption. Warming up z Full throttle and warming up at idle speed increase wear, fuel consumption, exhaust emission, the amount of pollutant in the exhaust and the amount of noise. z Drive off as soon as possible after starting. Uniform speed z Hectic driving significantly increases fuel consumption, the exhaust emissions, the proportion of pollutant in the exhaust gas and the noise level. z Do not accelerate and brake unnecessarily. Drive at uniform speed, watching the road. Avoid frequent starting-off and stopping e.g. at traffic lights, in short distance traffic and in queues of traffic by means of clever planning. Select roads with good traffic flow. Idling z The engine also consumes fuel when idling. z If you have to wait for more than one minute, it is worthwhile switching off the engine. Five minutes of idling corresponds to approximately 0.6 miles (1 km) of driving. Saving fuel, protecting the environment Overrun z The fuel supply is automatically shut off during overrun, e.g. when the vehicle is being driven down long gradients or when braking – see page 197. z To enable the overrun cut-off to come into action and save fuel, do not accelerate or declutch during overrun. Correct gear selection z High revs increase engine wear and fuel consumption. z Do not race your engine. Avoid driving at high engine speeds. Making use of the tachometer helps to save fuel. Drive in a low engine speed range for each gear as much as possible with uniform engine speeds. Drive as often as possible in top gear, select the next higher gear as soon as possible, and only change down when the engine is no longer running perfectly smoothly. High speed z The higher the speed, the higher the consumption and the noise level. At top speed, you consume a great deal of fuel and produce excessive noise and exhaust emissions. z Slightly releasing the accelerator pedal results in distinct fuel savings with no major loss of speed. Drive at no more than around three quarters of maximum speed and you will use up to 50 % less fuel, without losing a great deal of time. Tyre pressure z Inadequate tyre pressure, leading to higher road resistance, costs money in two ways: for more fuel and increased tyre wear. z Regular checks (every 14 days) pay off. Electrical loads z The power consumption of electrical equipment increases fuel consumption. z Switch off all auxiliary electrical loads (e.g. air conditioning 3, heated rear window) when not needed. Roof racks, ski-holders z Due to air resistance, a roof load can increase fuel consumption by approx. 3.5 gal./1000 miles (1 l/100 km). z Remove them if they are not being used. 199 Repair and maintenance z Improper repairs or adjustment and maintenance work can increase fuel consumption. Do not carry out work on the engine yourself. You may out of ignorance infringe environmental laws by not disposing of materials properly. Appropriate parts might not be recycled. Contact with some of the materials involved may pose a health hazard. z We recommend that repair and maintenance be entrusted to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Extreme driving conditions z Going up steep slopes, cornering, driving on poor roads and winter driving all increase fuel consumption. Fuel consumption increases dramatically in urban traffic and at winter temperatures, especially on short trips when the engine operating temperature is not reached. z Follow the hints given above to keep consumption to a minimum under such conditions. 200 Fuel consumption, fuel, refuelling Fuel consumption, fuel, refuelling Fuel consumption Fuel for petrol engines Fuel consumption is determined under specific driving conditions – see page 313. Commercially available high-quality fuels are suitable (catalytic converter – see page 203, octane numbers – see pages 308, 309). Fuel quality has a decisive influence on the power output, running behaviour and service life of the engine. The additives contained in the fuel play an important role in this regard. You should therefore only use high-quality fuels containing additives. Special equipment increases the weight of the vehicle. As a result, they can increase fuel consumption and reduce the specified maximum speed. For the first few thousand miles, friction between the engine and transmission components is higher. This increases fuel consumption. Fuel with too low an octane number can cause pinking. Vauxhall cannot be held liable for resulting damage. Petrol with a higher octane number can always be used. Fuel consumption ................................ Fuel for petrol engines ........................ Fuel for diesel engines......................... Fuel filler cap........................................ Refuelling.............................................. 200 200 201 201 201 Pump nozzles for leaded fuel cannot be inserted into the filler neck of vehicles that operate on unleaded fuel. The ignition timing adjusts automatically to the grade of fuel used (octane number) – see pages 308, 309. Use of petrol with an octane rating of 95 will ensure economical driving. For vehicles with Z20 LEH1) engine, use of 95 RON fuel reduces performance and torque. 1) Sales designation – see page 308. Fuel consumption, fuel, refuelling Fuel for diesel engines Fuel filler cap Diesel engines must be operated only on commercially available diesel fuel meeting the specifications of DIN EN 590. If replacing the fuel filler cap, be sure to use a genuine Vauxhall fuel filler cap for your model to ensure full functionality. Dieselengined vehicles have special fuel filler caps. Since January 2004, some oil companies have mixed their diesel fuel with upto 5% Bio fuel (FAME = Fatty Acid Methyl Esters) like RME (Rape-Oil Methyl Ester). This is in accordance with the current DIN EN 590 and does not harm the fuel / injection system. The characteristics of a diesel fuel mixed up with 5% Bio fuel (FAME) do not differ from conventional diesel fuel and do not influence the vehicle’s driveability. Important: Diesel fuel mixed with 5% FAME according to DIN EN 590 must not be confused with 100% Bio Diesel, which is not to be used in Vauxhall engines. The flow and filterability of diesel fuel are temperature-dependent. Diesel fuels with improved low temperature properties are therefore available on the market during the winter months. Make sure that you fill the tank with winter fuel before the start of the cold weather season. Additives can be used with diesel fuels with winter properties that are guaranteed by the manufacturer and when using diesel fuel filters that are heated depending on the outside temperature. 201 Picture no: 17197t.tif Refuelling 9 Warning Care must be taken when handling fuel. Before refuelling, switch off the engine and where applicable any auxiliary heating with combustion chambers (see sticker on fuel filler cap). Switch off mobile phones. 6 202 Fuel consumption, fuel, refuelling Correct filling depends to a large extent on proper operation of the fuel dispensing pump: 9 Warning Fuel is flammable and explosive. avoid naked flames or sparks when handling fuel or just in its vicinity. Do not smoke. This also applies where fuel is perceptible only from its characteristic odour. If fuel odours occur in the vehicle itself, eliminate the cause immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 1. Fully insert the pump nozzle and switch it on. 2. After automatic switch off, the specified tank capacity is reached after continued, measured filling. Leave the filler nozzle in place until the stop. To close, position the fuel filler cap and rotate past the resistance until the cap audibly clicks over the retainer. Picture no: 17198t.tif Fuel filler neck at right rear side of vehicle. The tank flap is locked together with the doors – see page 76. Open the tank flap. To open, unscrew the fuel filler cap, remove and suspend from the tank flap. The fuel tank has a limiting system which prevents overfilling of the tank. Close fuel tank cover. Wipe off any overflowing fuel immediately. Catalytic converter, exhaust gases Catalytic converter, exhaust gases Damage to the catalytic converter or the vehicle may result if the following points are not observed: z Consult a workshop, such as your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, as quickly as possible in the event of misfiring, irregular engine running following a cold start, a significant loss of engine power or other unusual malfunctions which may indicate a fault in the ignition system. If necessary, driving may be continued for a short time at a low speed and with a low engine speed. Picture no: 17199t.tif Catalytic converter for petrol engines Catalytic converter for petrol engines Catalytic converter for diesel engines Controlling exhaust emission.............. Exhaust gases ...................................... Maintenance ........................................ 203 203 204 205 206 207 Leaded fuel will damage the catalytic converter and parts of the electronic system, rendering them inoperative. High quality fuels other than those listed on pages 200 and 308 (e. g. LRP1)) could damage the catalytic converter. On vehicles with a catalytic converter, the fuel tank filler neck is of a narrow design so that a dispensing pump for leaded fuel cannot be inserted. 1) LRP = Lead Replacement Petrol. Irregular engine running and a loss of engine power when the Electronic Stability Programme (ESP®Plus 3) comes into action are the result of operating conditions and are therefore of no significance – see page 208. 6 204 Catalytic converter, exhaust gases z If unburnt fuel enters the catalytic converter, this may result in overheating and irreparable damage to the catalytic converter. You should therefore avoid unnecessarily long use of the starter when starting-off, running the tank dry (an irregular fuel supply will lead to overheating) and starting the engine by pushing or towing. z If the emission control indicator Z flashes, slow down until the flashing stops and the control indicator is steady. Consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. For emission control indicator Z – see page 205. Catalytic converter for diesel engines Damage to the catalytic converter or the vehicle may result if the following points are not observed: z Consult a workshop, such as your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, as quickly as possible in the event of irregular engine running, a significant loss of engine power or other unusual malfunctions. If necessary, driving may be continued for a short time at a low speed and with a low engine speed. Irregular engine running and a loss of engine power when the Electronic Stability Programme (ESP®Plus 3) comes into action are the result of operating conditions and are therefore of no significance – see page 208. Catalytic converter, exhaust gases 205 Flashing with the engine running indicates a fault that may damage the catalytic converter. You can continue to drive without causing damage by slowing down until the flashing stops and the control indicator is steady. Consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17004t.tif Controlling exhaust emission Through design-related measures – mainly in the area of the fuel-injection and ignition systems – the proportion of noxious materials in the exhaust, such as carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbons (HC) and nitrogen oxides (NOx), is reduced to a minimum. Picture no: 17352t.tif Control indicator Z for exhaust Illuminates when the ignition is switched on and during the start attempt. Goes off shortly after the engine starts running. If it illuminates while the engine running there is a fault in the emission control system. The permitted emission values may be exceeded. Consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 206 Catalytic converter, exhaust gases If it illuminates briefly, but does not recur, it is of no significance. Illumination of A could indicate the presence of water in the diesel fuel filter 3. A text message will appear in the service display at the same time – see page 44. Have the fuel filter checked for moisture. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17028t.tif Control indicator A for engine electronics Illuminates for a few seconds after the ignition is switched on. If it illuminates when the engine is running, there is a fault in engine or transmission electronics. The electronic system switches to an emergency running programme. Fuel consumption may be increased and the driveability of the vehicle may be impaired. In some cases, the fault can be remedied by switching the engine off and on again. If the control indicator illuminates again when the engine is running, consult a workshop to have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. If it flashes after the ignition is switched on, there is a fault in the electronic immobiliser system. The engine cannot be started – see page 67. Exhaust gases 9 Warning Engine exhaust gases contain poisonous carbon monoxide, which is colourless and odourless and could be fatal if inhaled. If exhaust fumes penetrate the vehicle interior, open the windows and consult a workshop immediately. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. During the first drive smoke may develop because of wax and oil evaporating on the exhaust system. Park the vehicle in the open for a while after the first drive and avoid inhaling the fumes. Catalytic converter, exhaust gases Maintenance Have all maintenance work carried out at the intervals specified by Vauxhall. We recommend that you entrust this work to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who has proper equipment and trained personnel available. Electronic testing systems permit rapid diagnosis and remedy of faults. This way you can be certain that all components of the vehicle’s electrical, injection and ignition systems operate correctly, that your vehicle has a low level of pollutant emission and that the catalytic converter system will have a long service life. You are thereby making an important contribution towards keeping the air clean and compliance with emissions legislation. Checking and adjustment of the fuelinjection and ignition systems is part of the scope of a Service. For this reason you should have all maintenance work carried out at the intervals specified in your Service Booklet. 207 208 Drive control systems Drive control systems Interactive Driving System (IDS+) 3 IDS+ unites the sensors and control units of the Electronic Stability Programme (ESPPlus), Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) and Continuous Damping Control (CDC). This provides both excellent driving dynamics and greater safety. Electronic Stability Programme (ESPPlus) 3 Interactive Driving System .................. Electronic Stability Programme .......... Continuous Damping Control 3 ......... SPORT mode 3 .................................... Cruise control 3 ................................... Parking distance sensors 3................. Automatic Level Control 3 ................. Deflation Detection System ................ Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 ... 208 208 210 210 212 214 216 217 218 ESPPlus improves driving stability when necessary in any driving situation regardless of the type of road surface or tyre grip. It also prevents the drive wheels from spinning. The system monitors vehicle movements. As soon as the vehicle starts to swerve (understeers / oversteers) engine output is reduced (the sound of the engine changes) and individual wheels are specifically braked. This considerably improves the driving stability of the vehicle on snow and ice and on wet or slippery road surfaces. ESPPlus is ready for operation as soon as the ignition is switched on and control indicator v goes out. When the ESPPlus comes into action, v flashes. The vehicle is now in a critical situation; ESPPlus allows you to keep control of the vehicle and reminds you to match your speed to the road conditions. 9 Warning Do not let this special safety feature tempt you into taking risks when driving. Traffic safety can only be achieved by adopting a responsible driving style. Drive control systems 209 Illuminates while driving The system is switched off or a fault is present. Continued driving is possible. The driving stability can however deteriorate depending on road surface conditions. Reactivate ESPPlus or have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allow faults to be quickly remedied. Picture no: 17200t.tif Control indicator v Illuminates for a few seconds when the ignition is switched on. The system is now ready for operation. Flashing during driving This shows the system has come into action. The engine output may be reduced (the sound of the engine changes) and the vehicle may be braked automatically to a small degree. Switching off 3 With SPORT mode 3 engaged (LED in SPORT button illuminated), the ESPPlus can be disengaged for sports performance. Hold the SPORT button depressed for around 4 seconds. Control indicator v will illuminate. ESP off will also appear in the service display – see page 44. 9 Warning Plus ESP should not be deactivated if there is one of the run-flat tyres 3 has no pressure. Picture no: 17961t.tif ESPPlus is reactivated by pressing the SPORT button again or switching on the ignition. SPORT mode – see page 210. 210 Drive control systems Continuous Damping Control 3 (CDC) SPORT mode 3 SPORT mode is used to change damping 3, steering 3, throttle application 3 and the shift point for automatic transmission and Easytronic 3 while driving. CDC adapts vehicle damping to the current driving situation and road conditions. The system continually monitors wheel and vehicle movements and immediately modifies the damping of each shock absorber. Chassis calibration is optimally adapted to the driving situation and road conditions. When SPORT mode is engaged, the damping control is adapted to a sportier driving style ("harder" chassis calibration). SPORT mode – see right column. Damping and steering become more direct and provide better contact with the road surface. The engine reacts more quickly to accelerator movements. Picture no: 17201t.tif Control indicator IDS+ for Continuous Damping Control (CDC) Illuminates for approx. 10 seconds after the driver’s door is opened. If it illuminates while driving, there is a fault in the system. The system is not operational. For reasons of safety "harder" chassis calibration will be activated. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. For automatic transmission 3 and Easytronic 3, the shift times are reduced and gear changes occur at a higher engine speed (except when cruise control is on). Drive control systems 211 To deactivate Briefly press the SPORT button again or switch off the ignition. The LED in the button goes out. A long press deactivates ESP – see page 209. SPORT mode remains engaged. SPORT mode is deactivated if the Winter programme 3 is switched on (vehicles with automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3). Winter programme – see pages 177, 185, 192. Picture no: 17961t.tif To activate Press the SPORT button. The LED in the button illuminates. In vehicles with automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3, control indicator 1 also illuminates. SPORT mode cannot be activated if the Winter programme 3 is running (vehicles with automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3). Winter programme – see pages 177, 185, 192. Picture no: 17201t.tif Control indicator IDS+ for SPORT mode Illuminates for approx. 10 seconds when the driver’s door is opened. If it illuminates while driving, there is a fault in the system. The system is not operational. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. 212 Drive control systems Cruise control 3 Cruise control can store and maintain speeds between 20 and 125 mph (30 and 200 km/h). Deviation from the stored speed may occur when driving up or downhill. For safety reasons the cruise control cannot be activated until the foot brake has been operated once. Cruise control is operated with buttons m, g, and § on the turn signal stalk. Do not use the cruise control if it is not advisable to maintain a constant speed (e.g. in situations presenting a danger to yourself and other road users, in heavy traffic or on winding, slippery or greasy roads). With automatic transmission 3, only use cruise control in D or in automatic mode with Easytronic 3. When the cruise control is active, reaction times may be increased due to the different position of the feet. 9 Warning The driver is always responsible for ensuring that vehicle speed is appropriate for the speed limit and driving conditions – even if cruise control is engaged. Failure to follow the instructions could lead to injuries or endanger life. Picture no: 17202t.tif Control indicator m When driving, control indicator m will illuminates as soon as the system is switched on. Drive control systems Picture no: 16990t.tif To activate Briefly press button m: the current speed is stored and maintained. The accelerator pedal can be released. Vehicle speed can be increased by depressing the accelerator pedal. When the accelerator pedal is released, the previously stored speed is resumed. 213 Increase With cruise control active, hold down button m or briefly press it repeatedly: speed is increased continuously or in steps of 1.2 mph (2 km/h) without using the accelerator pedal. To deactivate Briefly press button §: cruise control is switched off, control indicator m goes out and the vehicle slowly decelerates. To continue driving, depress the accelerator pedal in the usual manner. When button m is released the current speed is stored and maintained. For reasons of safety, cruise control deactivates under certain driving conditions. Decelerate With cruise control active, hold down button g or briefly press it repeatedly: speed is reduced continuously or in steps of 1.2 mph (2 km/h). When button g is released the current speed is stored and maintained. For example: z the vehicle’s speed drops below approx. 20 mph (30 km/h) or z the brake pedal is depressed or z the clutch pedal is depressed or z selector lever of automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3 in N. Resuming the stored speed Briefly press button g at a speed above 20 mph (30 km/h): the speed selected before the cruise control was switched off is resumed. The value of the stored speed is deleted when the ignition is turned off. 214 Drive control systems If the vehicle approaches an obstacle when reversing, a series of signals can be heard in the vehicle interior. The interval between the signals becomes shorter as the distance is reduced. If the distance is less than 30 cm, the signal will be continuous. 9 Warning Picture no: 17203t.tif Parking distance sensors 3 Parking distance sensors make reverse parking easier by measuring the distance between the vehicle and an obstacle in the rear, and giving an acoustic signal in the passenger’s compartment. The system records the distance using four sensors in the rear bumper. Picture no: 17016t.tif To activate The parking distance sensors activates automatically when the ignition is switched on and reverse gear is engaged. Its operational readiness is indicated by illumination of the LED in the button. Under certain circumstances, various reflective surfaces on objects or clothing as well as external noise sources may cause the system to fail to detect obstacles. For this reason, care must be taken when reversing even if the parking distance sensors are operational. This is of particular importance when in the vicinity of pedestrians. To deactivate The system deactivates automatically when reverse gear is disengaged. To deactivate the system when reverse gear is engaged, press button r. The LED in the button goes out. To reactivate, press button r again. Drive control systems 215 If it flashes The fault is due to sensors obstructed with snow or ice. The sensors must be undamaged and free of dirt, snow and ice. Caravan / Trailer towing equipment 3, caravan / trailer towing The system automatically detects if a towbar is properly fitted to the vehicle. Interference due to external sources of ultrasound (e.g. pneumatic drills, rotary machines). Once the source of interference is removed, the system will operate normally. When towing, parking distance sensors are automatically deactivated when the trailer cable is plugged into the socket. Fitting rear load racks 3 Rear load racks, e.g. bicycle racks, fitted near the sensors could disrupt the system. Observe the note on the Astra TwinTop on page 149. Picture no: 17204t.tif Control indicator r for parking distance sensors If it is illuminated: Fault in the system. The system is not ready for operation. Have the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. 216 Drive control systems The vehicle is automatically raised at the rear, increasing the spring travel and ground clearance. The Automatic Level Control system is activated after approx. 1.8 miles (3 kilometres), depending on the vehicle loading and the nature of the road surface. Headlight range adjustment – see page 136. Picture no: 17205t.tif Automatic Level Control 3 Automatic Level Control makes it possible to keep the height of the vehicle constant when subjected to different loads in the rear (e.g. when towing a caravan or trailer). This significantly improves driving conditions. In the event of malfunctions, do not utilise the vehicle’s full load capacity. Have the cause remedied without delay. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Drive control systems 217 Control indicator w If control indicator w illuminates red while driving, there is a loss of pressure. Stop immediately and check tyre pressures. A maximum speed of 50 mph (80 km/h) is permitted for run-flat tyres 3. Observe the information on page 231. Picture no: 17018t.tif Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3 The Deflation Detection System continuously monitors the speed of all wheels while driving. If a tyre loses pressure, it grows smaller and rotates more quickly than the other wheels. If the system detects a difference in speed, control indicator w illuminates red. Stop immediately and check tyre pressure. Mount the spare wheel if necessary – see pages 249, 252. The system is operational when the ignition is switched on and can detect pressure loss from a speed of 20 mph (30 km/h). If control indicator w illuminates yellow, there is a fault in the system. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. The control indicator flashes three times when the system is initialising. 9 Warning The Deflation Detection System does not replace manual checks with a suitable gauge. Check tyre pressures at least every 14 days and prior to any long journey; the tyres should be checked when cold. Don’t forget to check the spare 3. Tyre pressure – see pages 228, 326. Picture no: 17019t.tif System initialisation After correcting tyre pressure or changing a tyre / wheel, the system must be initialised: with the ignition switched on, press the DDS button for approx. 4 seconds. Control indicator w flashes 3 times. The system is operational after driving a certain distance. Only initialise the system if all tyres have the prescribed pressure. 218 Drive control systems Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 The tyre pressure monitoring system continually checks the pressure and speed of all four wheels while driving. A pressure sensor is integrated in each wheel. Once a minute, the pressure of each tyre is sent to a control unit, where it is compared. If the system detects one or more pressure differences, a message appears on the information display. In vehicles with Graphical Information Display 3 or Colour Information Display 3 and trip computer 3, current tyre pressures can be shown in the information display. For the system to be operational, all wheels must be equipped with pressure sensors and all tyres must be filled to the prescribed pressure. The tyre pressure monitoring system automatically detects if the vehicle is being driven with a load of up to 3 persons or a full load. Once the ignition is switched on, the system is operational and will continuously monitor the tyre pressures at speeds of approx. 20 mph (30 km/h) and above. 9 Warning The tyre pressure monitoring system does not replace manual checks with a suitable gauge. Check tyre pressures at least every 14 days and prior to any long journey; the tyres should be checked when cold. Don’t forget to check the spare 3. Tyre pressure – see pages 228, 326. Ü Board Computer BC 1 BC 2 Timer Tyres Picture no: 17334t.tif Display of current tyre pressure 3 Select menu item Tyres from the Board Computer menu. The current pressure of each tyre is displayed. Warning messages A message is given on the information display to warn of inconsistent tyre pressures. In some versions, the message is displayed in abbreviated form. For example, the following messages can be displayed: Drive control systems Navi active Navi active Tyre pressure Attention! check rear left tyre (value in bar) Front left tyre pressure loss (value in bar) OK Picture no: 17353t.tif A graphic 3 indicating the left rear tyre is shown together with the current tyre pressure: slight pressure deviation. Reduce speed. Check pressure at next opportunity with appropriate gauge and correct if necessary. On the Colour Information Display this report will appear in yellow. OK Picture no: 17354t.tif A graphic 3 indicating the front left tyre is shown together with the current tyre pressure: significant pressure deviation or direct pressure loss! Steer out of flow of traffic as quickly as possible without endangering other drivers. Stop and check the tyres. 219 Mount the spare wheel if necessary – see pages 249, 252. A maximum speed of 50 mph (80 km/h) is permitted for run-flat tyres 3. Observe the information on page 231. On the Colour Information Display this report will appear in red. Acknowledgement of warnings – see page 54. 220 Drive control systems General information The spare wheel / temporary spare is not equipped with a pressure sensor. The tyre pressure monitoring system is not operational if the spare wheel / temporary spare is in use. Control indicator w illuminates yellow –.– appears in the display of tyre pressures. Tyre pressure is monitored by the Deflation Detection System – see page 217. Picture no: 17018t.tif Control indicator w If control indicator w illuminates yellow while driving, there is a fault in the tyre pressure monitoring system. Fitting a wheel without pressure sensor (e.g. spare wheel) will also generate a fault in the system. Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. Picture no: 17019t.tif System initialisation The system must be initialised after a wheel / tyre change: with the ignition switched on, press button DDS approx. 4 seconds. Control indicator w flashes 3 times. The system is operational after driving a certain distance. Only initialise the system if all tyres have the prescribed pressure (check when tyres are cold). If a complete set of wheels without tyre pressure control system sensors is mounted (e.g. four winter tyres), no error message will be displayed. The tyre pressure monitoring system is not operational. The tyre pressure of a set of wheels without sensors is monitored by the Deflation Detection System (DDS) – see page 217. Drive control systems Sensors for the tyre pressure monitoring system can be retro-fitted. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. When manually checking tyre pressure with a pressure gauge, screw the adapter onto the valve. Tyre pressure – see page 326. The tyre pressure monitoring system valve cores and sealing rings must be replaced each time the tyres are changed. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The use of commercially available liquid filled run-flat systems or repair kits can impair the function of the system. Vauxhall-approved systems can be used. Radio transmitters (e.g. radio headphones, walkie-talkies) operated in the area could cause interference in the tyre pressure monitoring system. 221 222 Brakes Brakes Brake system The effectiveness of the brakes is an important factor for traffic safety. To improve effectiveness, do not brake unnecessarily hard for the first 125 miles (200 km) after new brake pads have been fitted. Brake pad wear must not exceed a specified limit. Regular maintenance as detailed in the Service Booklet is therefore of the utmost importance for traffic safety. Brake system........................................ 222 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS u)........ 224 Have worn brake pads replaced. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will fit pads that have been tested and approved by Vauxhall and guarantee optimum braking power. Brake pads worn to their minimum thickness generate a grinding noise. Continued driving is possible. Have the brake pads replaced as soon as possible by a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17206t.tif Brake assist Rapid powerful application of the brake pedal automatically applies maximum braking force amplification to achieve the shortest possible braking distance under full braking (brake assistant). Maintain steady pressure on the brake pedal for as long as full-on braking is to continue. When the brake pedal is released, the maximum brake force amplification is taken away. Adaptive brake light During full-on braking, all three brake lights flash for the duration of ABS control. Brakes Foot brake The foot brake comprises two independent brake circuits. If a brake circuit fails, the vehicle can still be braked using the other brake circuit. If this occurs, however, the brake pedal must be depressed quite far using considerable force before braking effect occurs. The distance required for braking will be greater. Consult a workshop before continuing your journey. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. To ensure the full pedal travel can be utilized, especially in case of a fault in one of the brake circuits, there must be no mats in the vicinity of the pedals – see page 197. When the engine is not running, the assistance of the brake servo unit disappears once the brake pedal has been depressed once or twice. Braking effect is not reduced, but braking requires significantly greater force. This is especially important to bear in mind when towing. 223 Check the brake lights before starting out on a journey. On vehicles with check control 3 the brake lights are checked automatically – see page 62. Shortly after starting each journey the effectiveness of the brake system should be tested at low speed and without inconveniencing other traffic, especially if the brakes are wet, e.g. after the vehicle has been washed. The brake fluid level should be checked regularly. If the brake fluid level is too low and the handbrake is not applied, control indicator R on the instrument panel illuminates – see page 38. Hill Start Assist 3 (HSA) The system helps pull away on inclines. After releasing the footbrake, if the handbrake is not applied the brakes are only released after 2 seconds. As soon as the acceleration is sufficient to prevent rolling back, the brake is released. Picture no: 17207t.tif Handbrake Always apply handbrake firmly. On slopes apply the handbrake as firmly as possible. The mechanical handbrake acts on the brakes on the rear wheels. It engages automatically when applied. To release the handbrake pull the lever up slightly, press the ratchet knob, and fully lower the lever. To reduce the operating forces of the handbrake, depress the foot brake at the same time. 224 Brakes Anti-lock Brake System (ABS u) ABS continually monitors the brake system and prevents the wheels from locking regardless of the type of road surface or tyre grip. Picture no: 17208t.tif Brake system control indicator R The control indicator illuminates when the ignition is switched on if the handbrake is applied or if the brake or clutch fluid level is too low. Brake fluid – see page 296. 9 Warning If the control indicator illuminates when the handbrake is not applied: stop. Interrupt your journey immediately. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. It starts to regulate the braking pressure as soon as a wheel shows a tendency to lock. The vehicle remains steerable, even in the event of very heavy braking, for instance on bends or when swerving to avoid an obstacle. Even in the case of full-on braking, the ABS makes it possible to drive round an obstacle without releasing the brakes. ABS control is made apparent through a pulse in the brake pedal and the noise of the regulation process. 9 Warning For optimum braking, keep the brake pedal fully depressed throughout the braking process, despite the fact that the pedal is pulsating. Do not reduce the pressure on the pedal. Do not let this special safety feature tempt you into taking risks when driving. Traffic safety can only be achieved by adopting a responsible driving style. Brakes 9 Warning If there is a fault in ABS, the wheels may be subject to locking due to braking that is heavier than normal. The advantages of ABS are no longer operational. You can continue driving, provided you drive with care and anticipation. Picture no: 17209t.tif Control indicator u for ABS The control indicator illuminates for several seconds when the ignition is switched on and the system undergoes a self-check at the same time (may be audible). The system is ready for operation when the control indicator goes out. If the control indicator does not go out after a few seconds, or if it illuminates while driving, there is a fault in the ABS. The brake system remains operational without ABS regulation. 225 Have the cause of the fault remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to be quickly remedied. 226 Wheels, tyres Wheels, tyres Tyres See page 326 for suitable tyres and restrictions. Tyres fitted in the factory are adapted to the chassis and provide optimum driving comfort and safety. Changing tyre / wheel type Before switching to different tyres or wheels, seek advice on the technical possibilities. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will be able to advise you of any necessary modifications. Tyres ..................................................... Changing tyre / wheel type................. Tyre pressure........................................ Tyre condition, wheel condition ......... Run-flat tyres (RFT) 3.......................... Winter tyres 3 ...................................... Wheel covers 3 .................................... Tyre chains ........................................... 226 226 228 229 231 232 232 232 If tyres of a different size than those fitted at the factory are used, the electronic speedometer may require reprogramming to ensure that the correct speed is displayed. 9 Warning Use of unsuitable tyres or wheels may lead to accidents and render the vehicle unroadworthy. Vehicles with tyre pressure monitoring system 3 If winter tyres or tyres of a different size are fitted, tyre pressure monitoring system sensors can be retro-fitted if so desired. Otherwise, the system will not indicate tyre pressure deviations. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3 – see page 217. Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 – see page 218. Vehicles with run-flat tyres 3 When switching wheels, e.g. when switching to winter tyres, use run-flat tyres as there is no spare wheel or tyre repair kit in the vehicle. Run-flat tyres 3 – see page 231. Wheels, tyres Fitting new tyres Fit tyres in pairs or in sets, which is even better. Ensure that tyres on one axle are z the same size, z the same design, z the same make, z and have the same tread pattern. Fit directional tyres such that they roll in the direction of travel. The rolling direction is indicated by a symbol (e.g. an arrow) on the sidewall. Tyres fitted opposing the rolling direction (e.g. when a tyre is changed) should be refitted as soon as possible. This is the only way to obtain full benefit from the design properties of the tyre. Run-flat tyres 3 must not be combined with conventional tyres. 9 Warning We recommend that you have your tyres changed by your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will be familiar with the requirements of the law as regards disposal of tyres and can thus help to protect the environment and your health. 227 Some brands of tyres have a beaded edge for alloy wheels to protect against damage. If wheel trim is used on steel wheels with beaded-edge tyres, the following specification must be followed: z Use of wheel trims and tyres that approved by Vauxhall for the vehicle in question and thereby fulfil all requirements for the wheel and tyre combination. z If the wheel trims and tyres used are not Vauxhall-approved, the tyres must not have a beaded edge. 9 Warning Use of unsuitable tyres or wheel trims could lead to sudden loss of air and thereby accidents. 228 Wheels, tyres Picture no: 17211t.tif Tyre pressure Check tyre pressure, including the spare wheel, at least every 14 days and prior to any long journey; the tyres should be checked when cold. Don’t forget to check the spare. Use the valve cap key to make unscrewing the valve caps easier. The key is located on the inside of the tank flap. Picture no: 17212t.tif In vehicles with tyre pressure monitoring system 3 there is an adapter in the valve cap key. Screw adapter to valve before attaching tyre pressure gauge – see page 218. Picture no: 17213t.tif After having checked the tyre pressure, tighten the valve caps using the valve cap key. Tyre pressure – see page 326. Incorrect inflation pressures will impair safety, vehicle handling, comfort and fuel economy and will increase tyre wear. Do not reduce tyre pressure when the tyres are warm. Otherwise the pressure may drop below the permissible minimum when the tyres cool down. If the pressure is too low, this can result in considerable tyre warm-up and internal damage, leading to tread separation and even to tyre blow-out at high speeds. Wheels, tyres Hidden tyre damage is not eliminated by adjusting the inflation pressure. 229 Check tyres regularly for damage (foreign bodies, punctures, cuts, cracks, bulges in sidewalls). Check wheels for damage. In the event of damage or abnormal wear, consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 9 Warning Incorrect tyre pressure could lead to a flat tyre. 9 Warning Damage may lead to tyre blow-out. Picture no: 17214t.tif Tyre condition, wheel condition Drive over edges slowly and at a right angle if possible. Driving over sharp edges can lead to hidden tyre damage and wheel damage which is only noticed later on. When parking, ensure that the tyres are not pressed against the edge of the kerb. 230 Wheels, tyres General information z The danger of aquaplaning is greater if the tyres are worn. z Tyres age, even if they are used only very little or not at all. A spare wheel which has not been used for six years should be used with care. z Never fit used tyres the previous history and use of which you do not know. Picture no: 17215t.tif Tread depth Check tread depth regularly. If wear in the front is greater than that in the rear, move the rear wheels to the front axle and vice versa. Correct tyre pressure. For vehicles with Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3 or tyre pressure control system 3, initialise the system – see pages 217, 220. Picture no: 17216t.tif The legally permissible minimum tread depth (1.6 mm) has been reached when the tread has worn down as far as one of the wear indicators (TWI1)). A number of wear indicators are spaced at equal intervals around the tyre within the tread. Their position is indicated by markings on the tyre sidewall. For reasons of safety, tyres should be replaced when their tread depth has worn down to 2 to 3 mm (winter tyres: 4 mm). 1) TWI = Tread Wear Indicator. z So as not to impair brake cooling, use only wheel trims approved for use on your vehicle. Wheels, tyres Tyre designations Meanings: e.g. 195/65 R 15 91 H 195 = Tyre width in mm 65 = Aspect ratio (tyre height to tyre width) in % R = Belt type: Radial 15 = Rim diameter in inches 91 = Load index e.g.: 91 represents 618 kg H = Speed code Speed code letters: Q S T H V W Up to 100 mph (160 km/h) Up to 112 mph (180 km/h) Up to 118 mph (190 km/h) Up to 130 mph (210 km/h) Up to 150 mph (240 km/h) Up to 168 mph (270 km/h) Run-flat tyres (RFT) 3 Run-flat tyres have reinforced, selfsupporting sidewalls, which ensure that the tyres always have a certain amount of driveability, even when there is no pressure. Run-flat tyres are only permitted on vehicles with ESPPlus and tyre pressure monitoring system or Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3. 9 Warning 231 Driving with a damaged tyre A loss in tyre pressure is indicated by the tyre pressure monitoring system 3 or the Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3. If a tyre has no pressure, continued driving is possible z at a speed of max. 50 mph (80 km/h), z up to a distance of 50 miles (80 km). 9 Warning Even the tyre pressure of run-flat tyres must be checked regularly. When driving with a flat tyre, do not exceed a speed of 50 mph (80 km/h) or a distance of 50 miles (80 km). Check tyre pressures at least every 14 days and prior to any long journey; the tyres should be checked when cold. The vehicle will be more difficult to steer and handle and the braking distance will be longer. Depending on the manufacturer, run-flat tyres can be recognised by the designation ROF or SSR on the sidewall. They are only permitted in combination with Vauxhallapproved alloy wheels. This also applies to winter tyres. Adapt driving style and speed to the conditions at hand. Do not use a tyre repair kit. Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3 – see page 217. Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 – see page 218. 232 Wheels, tyres Winter tyres 3 Wheel covers 3 For notes on fitting new tyres – see page 226. If the wheel trims and tyres used are not Vauxhall-approved, make sure that the tyres do not have a beaded edge – see page 227. Limitations – see pages 231, 326. Winter tyres improve safety at temperatures below 7 °C and should therefore be fitted on all the wheels. The design of summer tyres means they have limited qualities for winter driving. If the maximum permissible speed for the winter tyres is less than that of the vehicle, a notice indicating the maximum permissible speed for the tyres must be affixed within the driver’s field of vision1). If you use the spare wheel when it is fitted with a summer tyre, the vehicle’s driveability may be affected, especially on slippery road surfaces. Obtain a replacement for the faulty tyre as soon as possible, and have the wheel balanced and fitted to the vehicle. 1) Varies from country to country on account of national regulations. Picture no: 17217t.tif Tyre chains See page 326 for restrictions. Tyre chains are only permitted on the drive wheels (front axle). Always use fine mesh chains that add no more than 10 mm to the tyre tread and the inboard sides (including chain lock). We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Wheels, tyres Wheel trim on steel wheels could come into contact with parts of the chain and be damaged. Remove the wheel trim – see page 252. Tyre chains may only be used at speeds up to 30 mph (50 km/h) and, when travelling on roads that are free of snow, they may be used for brief periods only since they are subject to rapid wear on a hard road and may snap. Temporary spare wheel Tyre chains must not be used on the temporary spare wheel. If you need to use tyre chains after suffering a flat front tyre, fit the temporary spare on the rear axle and transfer one of the rear wheels to the front axle. For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. Wheel changing – see page 252. Correct tyre pressure. Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3 – see page 217. Tyre pressure control system 3 – see page 218. 233 234 Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing 9 Warning Disregard of these notes can lead to injuries which may be fatal. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. Roof racks 3 For reasons of safety and to avoid damaging the roof, we recommend that you use the Vauxhall roof rack system approved for your vehicle. Consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Roof racks 3......................................... Towing equipment 3........................... Towing equipment with detachable coupling ball bar 3....... Stowage of coupling ball bar ............. Caravan and trailer loads................... Coupling socket load........................... Rear axle load during towing ............. Tyre pressure........................................ Trailer Stability Assist 3 (TSA) ............ Driving characteristics, towing tips .... Starting on inclines .............................. 234 235 235 238 239 240 240 240 240 241 242 Picture no: 17218t.tif Roof loads are not permitted on the Astra TwinTop. Model variants without roof railing Lift the covers from the fitting openings. Fasten the roof rack following the instructions that accompany the system. Attach roof rack at appropriate points, see enclosed roof luggage rack system instructions. Driving hints – see page 196. Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing 235 Towing equipment 3 Use only towing equipment that has been approved for your vehicle. We recommend entrusting the retro-fitting of towing equipment to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will advise you on any possible towed load increases. Your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer has instructions on how to install the towing equipment and make any necessary changes to the vehicle that affect the cooling system, heat shields or other equipment. Picture no: 17219t.tif Model variants with roof railing 3 Attach roof rack to roof railing at points shown in illustration, see enclosed roof luggage rack system instructions. Observe the note on the Astra TwinTop on page 149. Do not mount towing equipment to vehicles with Z 20 LEH1) engine. 9 Warning The coupling ball bar is to be removed when not towing. For installation dimensions of the trailer towing equipment – see pages 339, 340. Picture no: 17220t.tif Towing equipment with detachable coupling ball bar 3 Stowage of coupling ball bar In Hatchbacks, the coupling ball bar is in a pouch, fastened in the luggage compartment cargo box with a strap – see page 238. In Estates, the coupling ball bar is fastened with a strap in a compartment in the spare wheel well of the luggage compartment. 6 1) Sales designation – see page 308. 236 Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing Picture no: 17221t.tif Fitting the coupling ball bar Disengage and fold down the socket. Remove the sealing plug from the hole for the coupling ball bar and stow it in the luggage compartment. Picture no: 17222t.tif Checking the tensioning of the coupling ball bar z Red marking on turn knob points towards white marking on coupling ball bar. z Gap of approx. 6 millimetres between rotary knob and coupling ball bar. z Key is in lock at position 1. Picture no: 17223t.tif Otherwise, the coupling ball bar must be tensioned before it is inserted into the coupling housing: z Unlock coupling ball bar (key to position 1) – see Fig. 17222 T. z Pull turn knob out and then turn it clockwise as far as it will go – see Fig. 17223 T. Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing 237 Important Check that the coupling ball bar is correctly attached: z Green marking on turn knob points towards white marking on coupling ball bar. z No gap between turn knob and coupling ball bar. z Coupling ball bar must be seated firmly in coupling housing. Picture no: 17224t.tif Inserting the coupling ball bar Insert the tensioned coupling ball bar into the coupling housing and push firmly upwards until the coupling ball bar engages in position. The turn knob snaps back into its home position resting against the coupling ball bar. 9 Warning Do not touch the turn knob when inserting the coupling ball bar - risk of injury. Picture no: 17225t.tif Lock coupling ball bar (key to position 2 – see page 236, Fig. 17222 T). Remove key and press protective flap into position. When the coupling ball bar is locked the turn knob can no longer be pulled out. z Coupling ball bar must be locked and key must be removed. 9 Warning Towing a caravan / trailer is only permitted with a properly attached coupling ball bar. If the coupling ball bar cannot be properly attached, consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Eye for break-away stopping cable In the case of caravans / trailers with brake, attach the break-away stopping cable to the eye (arrow in Fig. 17225 T). 238 Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing Insert the sealing plug in the hole for the coupling ball bar. Fold away the socket – see page 236, Fig. 17221 T. Do not use steam-jet cleaners or other high-pressure cleaners to clean the coupling ball bar. Picture no: 17226t.tif Dismounting the coupling ball bar Unlock coupling ball bar (key to position 1 – see page 236, Fig. 17222 T). Pull out turn knob and then turn it clockwise as far as it will go. Pull coupling ball bar down out of the coupling housing and stow in compartment in the luggage compartment – see page 235. Picture no: 17220t.tif Stowage of coupling ball bar Hatchback Stow the coupling ball bar in the pouch and fasten it in the luggage compartment cargo box with the strap. Estate Stow the coupling ball bar in the compartment in the spare wheel well of the luggage compartment, fastening it with the strap. Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing Caravan and trailer loads1) The permissible caravan / trailer loads are vehicle-dependent and engine-dependent maximum values which must not be exceeded. The actual caravan / trailer load is the difference between the actual gross weight of the caravan / trailer and the actual coupling socket load with the caravan / trailer coupled. When the caravan / trailer load is being checked, therefore, only the caravan / trailer wheels – and not the jockey wheel – must be standing on the weighing apparatus. The permissible caravan / trailer loads for your vehicle are given in the vehicle documents. Unless otherwise stated, they are valid for gradients up to max. 12 %. 1) Observe national regulations. The permissible caravan / trailer load should be fully utilised only by drivers who are adequately experienced in towing large or heavy caravans / trailers. The permitted caravan / trailer load applies up to the specified incline and up to an altitude of 1000 metres above sea-level. Since engine power decreases as altitude increases because of the air becoming thinner, therefore reducing climbing ability, the permitted towing weight also decreases by 10 % for every 1000 metres of additional altitude. The towing weight does not have to be reduced when driving on roads with slight inclines (less than 8 %, e.g. motorways). 239 The actual caravan / trailer load plus the actual gross weight of the towing vehicle must not exceed the maximum permitted towing weight. For example, if the permitted Gross Vehicle Weight is utilised, the caravan / trailer load must only be used until the maximum permitted towing weight is reached. The maximum permitted towing weight is shown on the identification plate - see page 306. 240 Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing Coupling socket load Rear axle load during towing The coupling socket load is the load exerted by the caravan / trailer on the coupling ball. It can be varied by changing the weight distribution when loading the caravan / trailer. With a trailer coupled and the towing vehicle fully loaded (including all occupants), the permissible rear axle load (see identification plate or vehicle documents) may be exceeded by 65 kg and the permissible Gross Vehicle Weight by 45 kg for the Hatchback. For the Estate, the permissible rear axle load may be exceeded by 60 kg and the permissible Gross Vehicle Weight by 30 kg. If the permissible rear axle load is exceeded a maximum speed of 60 mph (100 km/h) applies (50 mph (80 km/h) if approved for use as a commercial vehicle). If national regulations specify a lower maximum speed for vehicles towing a trailer, this must be observed. The maximum permissible coupling socket load (75 kg) is specified on the towing equipment identification plate and in the vehicle documents. Always aim for the maximum load, especially in the case of heavy caravans / trailers. The coupling socket load should never fall below 25 kg. When measuring the coupling socket load, make sure that the drawbar of the loaded caravan / trailer is at the same height as it will be when the caravan / trailer is coupled with the towing vehicle loaded. Particularly important for caravans / trailers with tandem axle. Picture no: 17213t.tif Tyre pressure Increase the tyre pressure on the towing vehicle to the value specified for a full load – see page 326. Check the pressure of the spare wheel and caravan / trailer wheels. Trailer Stability Assist 3 (TSA) Trailer Stability Assist monitors vehicle movements when towing a caravan or trailer. If the system detects lurching movements, engine power is reduced and the vehicle / trailer combination is selectively braked until the lurching ceases. Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing Parking distance sensors 3 are deactivated when towing. Handling is greatly influenced by the loading of the caravan / trailer. Loads should therefore be secured so that they cannot slip and be placed in the centre of the caravan / trailer if possible, i.e. above the axle. Picture no: 17227t.tif Driving characteristics, towing tips In the case of caravans / trailers with brakes, attach breakaway stopping cable to eye. Before attaching the caravan / trailer, lubricate the ball of the caravan / trailer towing device. However, do not lubricate the ball if a stabiliser, which acts on the coupling ball, is being used to damp snaking. Check caravan / trailer lighting before starting to drive. The fog tail light on the vehicle is deactivated when towing a caravan / trailer. Trailers with LED turn signals must have a provision enables light monitoring for commercial bulbs. Turn signal control indicator – see page 40. In the case of trailers with low driving stability or caravans with a permitted gross vehicle weight of over 1300 kg (Hatchback) / 1200 kg (Estate), do not exceed a speed of 50 mph (80 km/h); the use of a friction-type stabiliser is highly recommended. Do not drive faster than 50 mph (80 km/h) if possible, even in countries where higher speeds are permitted. Make sure that you have enough room when cornering and avoid sudden manoeuvres. 241 If the caravan / trailer starts to sway, drive more slowly, do not attempt to correct the steering and brake sharply if necessary. If it is necessary to apply the brakes fully, depress the brake pedal as hard as possible. Remember that the braking distance for vehicles towing caravans / trailers with and without brake is always greater than that for vehicles not towing a caravan / trailer. 6 242 Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing When driving downhill, the brakes are under considerably more load when towing a caravan / trailer. For this reason, drive in the same gear as if driving uphill and drive at a similar speed. Before starting-off under extreme conditions (high combination weight, mountainous terrain with steep inclines), switch off all unnecessary electrical loads (e.g. heated rear window, air conditioning system 3, heated front seats 3). Automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3 in automatic mode will automatically select the driving programme with the optimum engine braking effect. Gear position 3, 2 or 1 can also be manually selected if required. The cooling fan is electrically operated. Its cooling power is therefore independent of the engine speed. Since a considerable amount of heat is generated at high engine speeds and less at slower speeds, do not shift down when climbing hills whilst the vehicle is still coping with the gradient in the higher gear. Picture no: 17228t.tif Starting on inclines For vehicles with manual transmission, the most favourable engine speed when starting-off on an incline is between 2500 and 3000 rpm for petrol engines and between 2000 and 2200 rpm for diesel engines. Hold engine speed constant, engage clutch gradually (let slip), release handbrake and open throttle. If possible, the engine speed should not drop during this procedure. For vehicles with automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3 in automatic mode, apply full throttle. Self-help Self-help Starting the engine with jump leads 3 Towing the vehicle............................... Towing service ..................................... Towing another vehicle....................... Warning triangle ¨ 3......................... First-aid kit (cushion) + 3................... Stowing in the luggage compartment Jack £ 3 and vehicle tools 3 ............ Changing wheels ................................. Tyre repair kit 3 ................................... Electrical system .................................. Fuses and the most important circuits they protect .......................... Bulb replacement ................................ Halogen headlight system.................. Xenon headlight system 3, Adaptive Forward Lighting system 3 ............................................ Front indicator lights ........................... Front fog lights 3................................. Tail lights .............................................. Number plate light .............................. Courtesy lights ..................................... 9 Warning 244 245 246 247 248 248 249 251 252 256 260 261 268 268 272 275 275 276 285 286 Disregard of these notes can lead to injuries which may be fatal. Vehicle passengers must be informed accordingly. Diesel fuel system, bleeding Never let the tank run dry! If control indicator Y illuminates, refuel as soon as possible. Refuel immediately if it flashes. It is possible to restart the engine if the tank has been run dry. A delayed start is to be expected. Switch on the ignition three times for approx. 15 seconds. Then attempt to start the engine for approx. 40 seconds1). If the engine does not start, wait at least 5 minutes and try again. If the engine does not start, consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 1) For engine Z 17 DTH: for technical reasons, only possible for 30 seconds. Sales designation – see page 309. 243 Starting Do not start with quick charger This prevents damage to electronic components. Do not start by pushing or towing Because your vehicle is fitted with a catalytic converter, it must not be started by pushing or towing – see page 203. Vehicle with the Open&Start system 3 must not be started by pushing or towing if the battery is discharged, since the steering column lock cannot be released. The vehicle can only be started using jump leads – see following page. 244 Self-help Starting the engine with jump leads 3 z Use auxiliary battery with same voltage (12 volts). Its capacity (Ah) must not be considerably less than that of the discharged battery. Voltage and capacity information can be found on the batteries. A vehicle with a discharged battery can be started using jump leads and the battery of another vehicle. Attempts to start the vehicle should be made at intervals of one minute and should not last longer than 15 seconds. z Use jump leads with insulated terminals and a cross section of at least 16 mm2 (25 mm2 for diesel engines). 9 Warning This must be done with extreme care. Any deviation from the following instructions could lead to personal injury or damage resulting from battery explosion, as well as to damage to the electrical systems in both vehicles. z Do not disconnect the discharged battery from the vehicle. Picture no: 17229t.tif z Switch off all unnecessary electrical consumers. z Never expose the battery to naked flames or sparks. z Do not lean over the battery during jump starting. z A discharged batter can freeze at temperatures of 0 °C. Defrost the frozen battery in a warm room before connecting jump leads. z Do not allow the terminals of one lead to touch those of the other lead. z Do not allow battery fluid to come into contact with eyes, skin, fabrics or painted surfaces. The fluid contains sulphuric acid which can cause injuries and damage in the event of direct contact. z Wear eye protection and protective clothing when handling a battery. z Do not touch the vehicles while jump starting. z Apply handbrake. Manual transmission or Easytronic 3 in neutral, automatic transmission 3 in P. Self-help 245 z Do not connect leads to negative terminal of discharged battery! z The connection point should be as far away from the discharged battery as possible. z Route the leads so that they cannot catch on rotating parts in the engine compartment. z Start the engine of the vehicle providing the jump start. Picture no: 17230t.tif Connect the leads in the order shown in the illustration: 1. Connect one end of the first jump lead to the positive terminal 1 of the battery providing the jump start (identified by "+" sign on battery case or terminal). 2. Connect the other end of this lead to the positive terminal 2 of the discharged battery ("+" sign). 3. Connect the first end of the other jump lead to the negative terminal 3 of the battery providing the start ("–" sign). 4. Connect the other end of the second jump lead 4 to ground on the other vehicle, e.g. engine block or screw connection in the engine suspension. z After 5 minutes, start the other engine. Attempts to start the vehicle should be made at intervals of one minute and should not last longer than 15 seconds. z After starting, allow both engines to idle for approx. 3 minutes with the leads connected. z In order to avoid excess voltage in the electrical system, before removing a lead, switch on an electrical consumer (e.g. lights, heated rear window) in the vehicle receiving the jump start. z Reverse above sequence exactly when removing leads. Picture no: 17231t.tif Towing the vehicle To open the cover concealing the towing eye socket at the front right of the vehicle: disengage the cover at the bottom and pull it off downwards. The towing eye is found in the stowage compartment for the jack 3 and vehicle 3 located under the spare wheel or in the stowage compartment together with the tyre repair kit 3 under the floor cover. Jack and vehicle tools – see page 251. Tyre repair kit 3 – see page 256. 6 246 Self-help Manual transmission or Easytronic 3 in neutral, automatic transmission 3 in N. Drive slowly. Do not drive jerkily. Excessive tractive force can damage the vehicle. 9 Warning Significantly greater force is required for braking: the brake servo unit is only operational when the engine is running. Picture no: 17232t.tif Screw in the towing eye anticlockwise as far as it will go until it stops in a horizontal position. Attach a tow rope 3 – or better still a tow rod 3 – to the eye. Switch on ignition to release steering column lock and to permit operation of brake lights, horn and windscreen wiper. Vehicles with the Open&Start system 3 must not be towed when the battery is discharged because the steering column lock cannot be released. Towing is only possible with the ignition switched on. Use jump leads to start the engine if necessary. Considerably greater steering force is necessary since this unit is operative only when the engine is running. To prevent the entry of exhaust fumes from the towing vehicle, switch on the air recirculation 3 and close the windows. Vehicles with automatic transmission 3 should be towed facing forward only and must not be towed faster than 50 mph (80 km/h) or further than 60 miles (100 km). If the transmission is defective, or if the above speed or distance is to be exceeded, the front axle must be raised off the ground. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will serve you best to get your vehicle back on the road. If the automatic clutch has been manually released in vehicles with Easytronic 3 because of an interruption to the power supply, towing is not permitted – see page 180. In this case, consult a workshop as soon as possible. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. After towing, unscrew the towing eye clockwise and refit the cover. Towing service Entrust your vehicle only to the towing service of your choice and obtain an estimate on towing costs before employing any towing service. In this way you avoid unnecessary costs and possible insurance problems during claim processing. Self-help Picture no: 17233t.tif Towing another vehicle To open the cover concealing the towing eye socket at the rear right of the vehicle: disengage the cover at the bottom and pull it off downwards. Picture no: 18017t.tif 247 Picture no: 17234t.tif On some model variants 3: remove the cover concealing the towing eye at the rear right of the vehicle by disengaging the tabs at the bottom and pulling off the cover from the top. Screw in the towing eye anticlockwise as far as it will go until it stops in a horizontal position. The towing eye is found in the stowage compartment for the jack 3 and vehicle 3 located under the spare wheel or in the stowage compartment together with the tyre repair kit 3 under the floor cover. Drive slowly. Do not drive jerkily. Excessive tractive force can damage the vehicle. Jack and vehicle tools – see page 251. Tyre repair kit 3 – see page 256. Attach a tow rope 3 – or better still a tow rod 3 – to the eye. After towing, unscrew the towing eye clockwise and refit the cover. Model variants with cover 3: install by inserting the bottom lugs of the cover 3 in the bumper, folding and then press the lugs at the top into place. 248 Self-help Picture no: 17235t.tif Warning triangle ¨ 3 Hatchback, Astra TwinTop Store warning triangle in rear luggage compartment wall: first fit warning triangle into recess on left and the insert in guide on right. To remove the warning triangle, lift to the right and pull out to the right. For vehicles with cargo box 3: lift the warning triangle with the right half of the cargo box. Pull out the warning triangle to the right. Picture no: 17236t.tif Estate Insert the warning triangle in the retaining straps of the tailgate inner panelling. Picture no: 17237t.tif First-aid kit (cushion) + 3 Hatchback Secure the first-aid kit to the right luggage compartment wall using the retaining strap. Self-help Picture no: 17238t.tif Estate Fasten the first-aid kit (cushion) to the left luggage compartment wall with a retaining strap. Picture no: 17985t.tif Astra TwinTop Store the first-aid kit (cushion) in the recess behind the strap in the left luggage compartment wall. Spare wheel 3 Some vehicles are equipped with a tyre repair kit instead of a spare wheel see page 256. 249 Picture no: 17239t.tif Stowing in the luggage compartment The spare wheel is located in the luggage compartment below the floor cover and is fastened with a nut. On Estates, there is also a spacer over the retaining nut. Stowing standard size tyres in the spare wheel well The spare wheel well is not designed for all sizes of commercially available tyres. If a larger wheel must be stowed in the spare wheel well after changing wheels, place the floor cover on the overlaying wheel. This must be observed when loading the vehicle, especially for the Astra TwinTop. 250 Self-help General information Depending on model variant, the spare wheel may take the form of a temporary spare wheel 3. Refer to the notes on pages 233, 255 and 326. On vehicles with alloy wheels 3 the spare wheel may have a steel rim. Picture no: 17240t.tif Estate Remove the adapters 3 and hooks 3 from the rails 3 in the luggage compartment walls. Raise the rear lashing eyes and lift the floor cover to a vertical position so that it is retained by the headliner. When closing, guide the lashing eyes through the slots in the floor cover. Notes on temporary spare wheel 3 z Using a temporary spare wheel may change the driving behaviour of the vehicle, particularly if using winter tyres 3. Replace defective tyre as quickly as possible, balance wheel and fit to vehicle. If you use winter tyres 3, the spare wheel may still be fitted with a summer tyre. If you use the spare wheel the vehicle’s handling may be altered. Obtain a replacement for the faulty tyre as soon as possible, and have the wheel balanced and fitted to the vehicle. z Fit only one temporary spare wheel. The spare wheel may have a smaller tyre and a smaller rim than the wheels mounted on the vehicle1): using the spare wheel may alter vehicle handling. Have the defective tyre replaced as soon as possible, balance the wheel and have it mounted on the vehicle. z Replace temporary spare wheel with full specification wheel without delay. Vehicles with cargo box 3: removal – see page 102. z Do not drive faster than 50 mph (80 km/h). z Take curves slowly. z Do not use the temporary spare wheel for a lengthy period. z Snow chains are not permitted on the temporary spare wheel. If tyre chains are necessary after a front wheel puncture, fit the temporary spare wheel to the rear and a rear wheel to the front. Check tyre pressure and adjust if necessary – see page 327. z Follow temporary spare wheel instructions on pages 233, 255 and 326. Astra TwinTop Accessing the spare wheel when the roof is open: engage luggage compartment cover on the rear window frame and activate the loading aid (see page 103). Raise the floor cover in the luggage compartment. 1) Country-specific version: the spare wheel is only to be used as a temporary spare wheel. Self-help 251 Notes on directional tyres 3 Directional tyres only provide maximum performance when they are mounted in the correct direction of rotation. If the tyres or spare wheel must be mounted opposing the specified direction of rotation (e.g. after changing a flat tyre), observe the following: z Vehicle handling may change. Have the defective tyre replaced as soon as possible, and have the wheel balanced and mounted on the vehicle. z Do not drive faster than 50 mph (80 km/h). z Be especially careful when driving in rain and snow. Further information on directional tyres – see page 226. Picture no: 17241t.tif Jack £ 3 and vehicle tools 3 The jack and the vehicle tools have been specially developed for your vehicle and must only be used on that vehicle. Only use jack for changing wheels. Vehicles with spare wheel 3: the jack and vehicle tools are stowed in a compartment in the luggage compartment beneath the spare wheel. Remove the spare wheel see page 249. Vehicles with tyre repair kit 3: the vehicle tools are stowed together with the tyre repair kit in a compartment beneath the floor cover in the luggage compartment. Picture no: 17242t.tif After use, stow away the jack and tools in the compartment as shown in illustration. Astra TwinTop: the tools for emergency operation of the convertible hardtop are stowed in the glove compartment. 252 Self-help Changing wheels There may be a tyre repair kit instead of a spare wheel – see page 256. To ensure your safety, make the following preparations and observe the following information when changing wheels: z Park the vehicle on a level, firm and nonskid surface. z Switch on hazard warning lights, apply handbrake, automatic transmission 3 – selector lever in P, manual transmission or Easytronic 3 – engage 1st or reverse gear. z Correctly set up the warning triangle. Warning triangle – see page 248. z Take the spare wheel from the luggage compartment. z Before raising the vehicle, set the front wheels to the straight-ahead position. z On the Astra TwinTop, the roof must be closed before the vehicle is raised. z Slacken the wheel bolts one half turn before raising the vehicle, but do not totally unscrew the bolts. z Never change more than one wheel at once. z No people or animals may be in the vehicle when it is jacked up. z Block the wheel diagonally opposite the wheel to be changed by placing wedge blocks or equivalent in front and behind the wheel. z Never crawl under a jacked-up vehicle. z Use the jack 3 only to change wheels. z If the ground on which the vehicle is standing is soft, a solid board (max. 1 cm thick) should be placed under the jack 3. Using a thicker board could damage the jack 3 and the vehicle. z Do not start or run the engine while the vehicle is on the jack. z Fully tighten the wheel bolts after lowering the vehicle all the way. Self-help Picture no: 17243t.tif 1. Prise off the wheel trim using the hook included with the vehicle tools 3. For vehicle tools – see page 251. For wheel trims with visible wheel bolts 3: the trim can remain on the wheel. Do not remove the retaining washers 3 on the wheel bolts. Picture no: 17244t.tif Alloy wheels 3: disengage the wheel bolt caps with a screwdriver and remove. Protect the wheel by inserting a soft cloth between the screwdriver and ally wheel. Picture no: 17245t.tif 253 2. Slacken wheel bolts using wheel bolt wrench 3, putting on the wheel bolt wrench as far as possible. 254 Self-help Picture no: 17246t.tif 3. The location of each jacking point 3 is indicated by a mark on the bottom edge of the vehicle. Picture no: 17247t.tif 4. Before positioning the jack 3, set it to the necessary height by rotating the eye by hand. Position the jack 3 at the front or rear so that the jack claw spans the vertical base and grips in the recess in the vertical base. Make sure it is properly positioned. The jack base must be on the ground directly below the jacking point in a manner that prevents it from slipping. Picture no: 17248t.tif Attach crank to eye of threaded rod and turn crank to raise vehicle. If this is not the case, carefully lower the vehicle immediately and reposition the jack. 5. Unscrew wheel bolts and put somewhere where the threads will not be soiled. If the wheel bolts have retaining washers 3, they must not be removed. Self-help 10. Before refitting the wheel trim, clean the wheel around the retaining clips. Valve symbol 3 on back of wheel trim must point towards valve on wheel. Align and refit wheel trim or wheel bolt caps 3. Alloy wheels 3: align and refit wheel bolt caps 3. 11. Stow replaced wheel, tools and warning triangle in luggage compartment – see pages 248 to 251. Picture no: 17249t.tif 6. Change the wheel. Notes on spare wheel – see page 249. Notes on temporary spare wheel – see page 250. 7. Screw in wheel bolts and tighten slightly, inserting the wheel bolt wrench 3 as far as possible. 8. Lower vehicle. 9. Tighten wheel bolts crosswise, putting on wheel bolt wrench 3 as far as possible. 12. Check the tyre pressure of the newly fitted wheel. Adjust as necessary. 255 13. Have the tightening torque of the wheel bolts on the new wheel checked on the vehicle using a torque wrench as soon as possible and, if necessary, corrected. Tightening torque – see page 326. 14. Replace the faulty tyre on the wheel that was removed. 15. Replace temporary spare wheel 3 with a full specification wheel without delay. 16. Initialise the Deflation Detection System (DDS) 3 or tyre pressure monitoring system 3 – see pages 217, 220. 256 Self-help Tyre repair kit 3 Minor damage to the tyre tread or side wall, e.g. from foreign bodies, can be repaired using the tyre repair kit (does not apply to run-flat tyres). Do not remove the foreign body from the tyre. Tyre damage exceeding 4 mm or that is on the rim cannot be repaired with the tyre repair kit. 9 Warning Driving with inadequate tyre pressure or a flat tyre can lead to hidden tyre damage, which cannot be eliminated by using the tyre repair kit. Part the vehicle and consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Important information – see page 259. In the event of a flat tyre: z Switch on hazard warning lights, apply handbrake, automatic transmission 3 – selector lever in P, manual transmission or Easytronic 3 – engage 1st or reverse gear. z Correctly set up the warning triangle. Warning triangle – see page 248. Picture no: 17250t.tif The tyre repair kit is in a compartment under the floor cover luggage compartment. 1. Take the pouch with the tyre repair kit from the compartment. Carefully remove the components from the pouch. 2. Remove the compressor. Picture no: 17251t.tif 3. Remove the electrical connection cable and air hose from the stowage compartments on the underside of the compressor. Self-help Picture no: 17252t.tif 4. Screw the compressor air hose to the connection on the sealant bottle. 5. Fit the sealant bottle in the retainer on the compressor. Set the compressor near the tyre in such a way that the sealant bottle is upright. 6. Remove the valve cap from the defective tyre. Picture no: 17253t.tif 7. Screw the filler hose to the tyre valve. 8. The switch on the compressor must be set to §. 9. Connect the compressor plug to the accessory socket or cigarette lighter socket. Accessory socket – see page 106. 257 Picture no: 17254t.tif 10. Set the rocker switch on the compressor to I. The tyre is filled with sealant. 11. While the sealant bottle drains (approx. 30 seconds) the pressure indicator on the compressor briefly points to 6 bar. Pressure then sinks again. 12. All of the sealant is pumped into the tyre. Afterwards, the tyre is filled with air. 13. The prescribed tyre pressure (see page 326) should be reached within 10 minutes. Switch off the compressor when the correct pressure is obtained. 258 Self-help Drain excess tyre pressure with the button over the pressure indicator. Do not run the compressor for more than 10 minutes – see "Important information" on page 259. 14. Detach the tyre repair kit. Screw the filler hose to the free connection on the sealant bottle. This prevents sealant leakage. Stow the tyre repair kit in the luggage compartment. 15. Wipe away any sealant spill with a cloth. Picture no: 17255t.tif If the prescribed tyre pressure is not reached within 10 minutes, detach the tyre repair kit. Move the vehicle one tyre revolution (approx. 2 metres) in or against the flow of traffic. Reconnect the tyre repair kit and continue the filling procedure for 10 minutes. If the prescribed tyre pressure is still not reached, the tyre is too badly damaged. Park the vehicle and consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 16. Dismantle the warning triangle and stow it in the luggage compartment – see page 248. 17. The enclosed sticker shows the maximum permitted speed at which the tyre repair may be used. Apply sticker in the driver’s field of vision. 18. Continue driving immediately to allow the sealant to distribute evenly throughout the tyre. Stop after approx. 6 miles (10 km) but no more than 10 minutes, and check tyre pressure. Screw the compressor air hose directly onto the tyre valve (see Fig. 17256 T). Picture no: 17256t.tif If tyre pressure is more than 1.3 bar (19 psi), adjust to the prescribed value. Repeat the procedure until there is no more pressure loss. If tyre pressure is below 1.3 bar (19 psi), the vehicle must not be driven. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 19. Stow the tyre repair kit in the luggage compartment – see page 256. Self-help Important 9 Warning Do not drive faster than 50 mph (80 km/h). Do not use the temporary spare wheel for a lengthy period. Steerability and driving behaviour may be impaired. The driving comfort of the repaired tyre is severely affected, therefore have this tyre replaced. If the compressor makes abnormal noises or heats up greatly, switch it off for at least 30 minutes. The integrated safety valve opens at a pressure of 7 bar (102 psi). Protect the compressor from moisture and rain. The sealant can only be stored for approx. 4 years. After this time, the sealing properties can no longer be guaranteed. Heed the expiration date on the sealant bottle. The sealant bottle can only be used once. Replace a used sealant bottle. The compressor and sealant can be used from approx. -30 °C. Dispose of a used tyre repair kit in accordance with applicable legislation. An adapter for filling air mattresses, inner tubes, etc. is located on the underside of the compressor. Remove by unscrewing the compressor air hose and pulling out the adapter. 259 260 Self-help Picture no: 17257t.tif Electrical system 9 Warning Electronic ignition systems generate very high voltages. Do not touch the ignition system; high voltage can be fatal. Fuses The vehicle has two fuseboxes: one behind a cover on the left side of the luggage compartment and one in the front left of the engine compartment. It is advisable to carry a complete set of fuses – available from any Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Store spare fuses in the luggage compartment fusebox – see illustration above. Opening the cover – see following pages. Picture no: 17258t.tif Before replacing a fuse, turn off the respective switch and the ignition. A blown fuse (see illustrations to the right) can be recognised by its melted wire. Do not install a new fuse until the cause of the fault has been remedied. There is a fuse extractor in the luggage compartment fusebox to facilitate replacement of small fuses – see illustration above for an example. Only fit fuses of the specified current rating. Each fuse has its current rating written on it, in addition the ratings are colour coded. Picture no: 17259t.tif Different versions of fuses are used. Fuse, colour Light brown Dark brown Red Light blue Yellow White Light green Fuse, rating 5A 7.5 A 10 A 15 A 20 A 25 A 30 A Self-help Picture no: 17260t.tif Fuse, colour Light blue White Pink (maxi-fuse) Dark green (maxi-fuse) Fuse, rating 20 A 25 A 30 A 40 A Picture no: 17261t.tif 261 Picture no: 18022t.tif Fuses and the most important circuits they protect 3-door Hatchback To open, fold the cover upwards. Fusebox in luggage compartment Depending on the equipment version, there are two different fuseboxes for differing electrical circuits. z Version A – see Fig. 17949 T z Version B – see Fig. 17958 T Astra TwinTop To open, pull the two knobs, remove the clips and fold the cover upwards. Astra TwinTop always has version B. Spare fuses, fuse extractor – see page 260. The fusebox is located on the left side of the luggage compartment behind a cover. Do not store any objects behind the cover. 5-door Hatchback and Estate To open, use a coin to turn the two latches as illustrated and fold the cover downwards. 262 Self-help Fusebox, version B Some functions are protected by several fuses. Picture no: 17949t.tif Fusebox, version A Some functions are protected by several fuses. To replace a fuse, pull off its protective cap. No. Circuit 1 Luggage compartment socket 2 Rear socket 3 Electric windows, front 4 Electric windows, rear 5 Heated exterior mirrors 6 Air conditioning system Rating 15 A 15 A 30 A No. Circuit 1 Electric windows, front 2 – 3 Instruments 4 Heating, air conditioning system, Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 3 5 Airbags 6 – 7 – 8 – 9 – 10 – 11 Heated rear window 12 Tailgate wiper Rating 25 A – 7.5 A 5A 7.5 A – – – – – 25 A 15 A No. Circuit 13 Parking distance sensors 14 Heating, air conditioning system 15 – 16 Seat occupancy recognition, Open&Start system 17 Rain sensor, air quality sensor, tyre pressure monitoring system, interior mirror 18 Instruments, switches 19 – 20 CDC 21 Heated exterior mirrors1) 22 Sunroof 23 Electric windows, rear 30 A 7.5 A 10 A 1) Not in conjunction with Vauxhall alarm system 3. Rating 5A 7.5 – 5A 5A 5A – 10 A 7.5 A 20 A 25 A Self-help No. Circuit 38 Central locking system, clamp 30 39 Seat heater (left) 40 Seat heater (right) 41 – 42 – 43 – 44 – No. 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 Picture no: 17958t.tif Circuit Diagnostics plug – Electrically retractable exterior mirrors Ultrasonic sensor, Vauxhall alarm system – Cigarette lighter, front socket Rear socket – Rating 7.5 A – 7.5 A 5A – 15 A 15 A – No. 32 33 34 35 36 37 Picture no: Circuit – Open&Start system Sunroof, TwinTop Rear socket Towing equipment Courtesy light Rating – 15 A 25 A 15 A 20 A 5A 263 Rating 25 A 15 A 15 A – – – – 264 Self-help Depending on the equipment version, there are two different fuse layouts for the engine compartment fusebox, handling different electrical circuits: z If the luggage compartment fusebox is version A – see Fig. 17949 T on page 262 – the fuse layout in the engine compartment is version A - see next column. Picture no: 17263t.tif Fusebox in engine compartment The fusebox is at the front left side of the engine compartment. Fuse layout, version A Some functions are protected by several fuses. No. 1 2 3 Circuit ABS ABS Interior fan climate control system 4 Interior fan, heating, air conditioning system 5 Radiator fan 11) z If the luggage compartment fusebox is version B – see Fig. 17958 T on page 263 – the fuse layout in the engine compartment is version B – see next page. Astra TwinTop always has version B. Rating 20 A 30 A 30 A 30 A 30 A 40 A Spare fuses, fuse extractor – see page 260. 9 Warning Turn off engine before opening engine compartment fusebox; risk of injury – see page 291. To open the cover, release the catch by inserting a screwdriver into the opening as far as it will go and swivelling it to the side. Open the cover upwards and remove. 1) Different ratings depending on engine and equipment level. Self-help No. 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 Picture no: 17264t.tif No. Circuit 6 Radiator fan 21) 7 Central locking system 8 Windscreen wash system, tailgate 9 Heated rear window, heated exterior mirrors 10 Diagnostics plug 11 Instruments 12 Mobile telephone, digital radio, Twin Audio, display 13 Courtesy light 1) Rating 20 A 30 A 40 A 20 A 10 A 30 A 7.5 A 7.5 A 7.5 A 5A Different ratings depending on engine and equipment level. No. 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 Picture no: Circuit Windscreen wiper Windscreen wiper Horn, ABS, brake light switch, air conditioning system Diesel filter or air conditioning system Starter Transmission electronics Horn Rating 30 A 30 A 5A 28 29 30 31 32 33 25 A 20 A 25 A 30 A 15 A 34 35 36 Circuit Engine electronics Engine electronics Headlight range adjustment Fuel pump Reversing lights Engine electronics Heating, air conditioning system, air quality sensor – Power steering Engine electronics Tailgate wiper Brake light switch Headlight range adjustment, light switch, clutch switch, instrument assembly, driver’s door module Control unit steering column module Infotainment system Cigarette lighter, front socket 265 Rating 20 A 7.5 A 5A 15 A 5A 10 A 7.5 A – 5A 10 A 15 A 5A 5A 7.5 A 20 A 15 A 266 Self-help Fuse layout, version B Some functions are protected by several fuses. No. 1 2 3 Circuit ABS ABS Interior fan climate control system 4 Interior fan, heating, air conditioning system 5 Radiator fan 11) 6 Radiator fan 21) 1) Rating 20 A 30 A 30 A 30 A 30 A 40 A 20 A 30 A 40 A Different ratings depending on engine and equipment level. No. 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Circuit Windscreen wash system Horn Headlight wash system – – – Front fog lights Windscreen wiper Windscreen wiper Rating 10 A 15 A 25 A – – – 15 A 30 A 30 A No. Circuit 16 Electronics control units, Open&Start system, ABS, brake light switch, TwinTop 17 Diesel filter heating 18 Starter 19 Transmission electronics 20 Air conditioning system 21 Engine electronics 22 Engine electronics 23 Adaptive Forward Lighting, headlight range adjustment Rating 5A 25 A 25 A 30 A 10 A 20 A 7.5 A 10 A Self-help No. 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 Picture no: 17264t.tif Circuit Fuel pump Transmission electronics Engine electronics Power steering Transmission electronics Transmission electronics Engine electronics Rating 15 A 15 A 10 A 5A 5A 7.5 A 10 A Picture no: No. Circuit 31 Adaptive Forward Lighting, headlight range adjustment 32 Brake system, air conditioning system, clutch switch 33 Adaptive Forward Lighting, headlight range adjustment, light switch 34 Control unit, steering column module 35 Infotainment system 36 Mobile telephone, digital radio, Twin Audio, display Rating 10 A 5A 5A 7.5 A 20 A 7.5 A 267 268 Self-help Bulb replacement Before replacing a bulb, switch ignition off and switch relevant switch off. Only hold new bulb at base! Do not touch the bulb glass with bare hands, otherwise fingerprints on the glass evaporate. Residue builds up on the reflector eventually resulting in a dull reflector. Inadvertently stained bulbs may be cleaned with a clean non-fluffy cloth, using alcohol or white spirits. Replacement bulb must be in accordance with data on base of defective bulb. Do not exceed wattage given on bulb base. Picture no: 17265t.tif The bulbs of the front external lights are replaced through openings in the front wheel arch: turn relevant wheels to gain access, release catch and remove cover. Headlight aiming We recommend that headlight aiming be carried out by your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will have special equipment. When adjusting headlights, headlight range adjustment must be set to 0. Picture no: 17266t.tif Halogen headlight system Headlights with separate systems for main beam 1 (inner bulbs) and dipped beam 2 (outer bulbs). Self-help Picture no: 17267t.tif Dipped beam 1. Replace bulb through opening the front wheel arch: turn relevant wheel to gain access, release catch and remove cover – see page 268. 2. Remove headlight protective cover. Picture no: 17268t.tif 3. Rotate left bulb holder and disengage. Picture no: 17269t.tif 269 4. Remove the bulb holder with bulb from the reflector. 270 Self-help Picture no: 17270t.tif Picture no: 17271t.tif 5. Detach bulb from bulb holder. Main beam 6. Insert new bulb into bulb holder, without touching the glass. 1. Open bonnet. 7. Insert new bulb so that the two lugs on the bulb holder engage in the recesses in the reflector. 8. Rotate bulb holder to right as far as it will go. 9. Place headlight protective cover in position and close. 10. Position cover on opening in wheel arch and engage. 2. Replace bulbs from engine compartment out. To replace the bulb on the right-hand side, remove the air hose from the air filter. To replace the bulb on the left-hand side, remove the plug from the fusebox. 3. Remove headlight protective cover. 4. Detach plug connector from bulb. Picture no: 17272t.tif 5. Disengage spring clip from retainer by pressing forward and then swing downward. 6. Remove bulb from reflector housing. 7. When fitting a new bulb, engage the lugs in the recesses on the reflector without touching the glass. Self-help 271 8. Engage spring wire clip, plug connector onto bulb. 9. Place headlight protective cover in position and close. After bulb replacement on the righthand side, reattach air hose to air filter and engage. After bulb replacement on the lefthand side, reconnect the fusebox plug and engage. Picture no: 17271t.tif Parking lights 1. Open bonnet. 2. Replace bulbs from engine compartment out. To replace the bulb on the right-hand side, remove the air hose from the air filter. To replace the bulb on the left-hand side, remove the plug from the fusebox. 3. Remove main beam headlight protective cover. Picture no: 17273t.tif 4. Remove parking light socket from reflector. 6 272 Self-help Picture no: 17274t.tif 5. Remove bulb from socket. 6. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 7. Insert holder in reflector. Place headlight protective cap in position and close. After bulb replacement on the righthand side, reattach air hose to air filter and engage. After bulb replacement on the left-hand side, reconnect the fusebox plug and engage. Picture no: 17275t.tif Xenon headlight system 3, Adaptive Forward Lighting system 3 Headlights with separate systems for dipped beam 1 (inner bulbs) and main beam 2 (outer bulbs). Dipped beam 9 Warning The dipped beam operates at very high voltage. Do not touch; high voltage can be fatal. Have bulbs changed by a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17276t.tif Main beam 1. Replace bulb through opening the front wheel arch: turn relevant wheel to gain access, release catch and remove cover – see page 268. 2. Remove headlight protective cover. Self-help Picture no: 17277t.tif 3. Rotate left bulb holder and disengage. Picture no: 17278t.tif 4. Remove the bulb holder with bulb from the reflector. 273 Picture no: 17270t.tif 5. Detach bulb from bulb holder. 6. Insert new bulb into bulb holder, without touching the glass. 7. Insert new bulb so that the two lugs on the bulb holder engage in the recesses in the reflector. 8. Rotate bulb holder to right as far as it will go. 9. Place headlight protective cover in position and close. 10. Position cover on opening in wheel arch and engage. 274 Self-help Picture no: 17276t.tif Parking lights 1. Open bonnet. 2. Replace bulb through opening the front wheel arch: turn relevant wheel to gain access, release catch and remove cover – see page 268. 3. Remove main beam headlight protective cover. Picture no: 17279t.tif 4. Remove parking light socket from reflector. Picture no: 17280t.tif 5. Remove bulb from socket. 6. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 7. Insert holder in reflector. Place headlight protective cap in position and close. 8. Position cover on opening in wheel arch and engage. Self-help 275 6. Insert light holder in reflector, rotate clockwise and engage in position. 7. Position cover on opening in wheel arch and engage. Front fog lights 3 Have the bulbs replaced by a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17281t.tif Front indicator lights 1. Open bonnet. 2. Replace bulb through opening the front wheel arch: turn relevant wheel to gain access, release catch and remove cover – see page 268. 3. Rotate bulb holder to left and disengage. Picture no: 17282t.tif 4. Push bulb into socket slightly, rotate left and remove. 5. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 276 Self-help Picture no: 17283t.tif Picture no: 17284t.tif Tail lights 2. Detach plug connector from bulb holder. Hatchback 5-door 1. To replace bulbs on the right side, use a coin to open the lock as indicated in the illustration and fold the cover down. 3. Hold outside of bulb housing, loosen fastening nuts with wheel bolt wrench 3 and unscrew by hand. Wheel bolt wrench 3 – see vehicle tools on page 251. To replace bulbs on the left side, use a coin to turn both locks as illustrated on page 261 in Fig. 17261 T and fold the cover down. Picture no: 17285t.tif 4. Detach bulb housing towards the rear. Self-help 277 6. Remove bulb from socket. 7. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 8. Engage bulb holder in bulb housing, ensuring that it properly engages. Insert three screws with washers and tighten as far as possible. Picture no: 17286t.tif 5. Unscrew three screws using a screwdriver (vehicle tools – see page 251). Press locking tabs on outside of bulb holder inward and remove the bulb holder. Picture no: 17287t.tif Bulbs in bulb holder: 1 = Reversing light 2 = Turn signal 3 = Tail light / brake light 4 = Tail light 5 = Fog tail light 278 Self-help 11. Carry out the following steps to ensure proper function of the tail lights: – switch on ignition, – operate brake, – switch on parking lights. Picture no: 17288t.tif 9. Ensure that the bulb holder seal is positioned as illustrated. Picture no: 17289t.tif 10. Insert the bulb housing in the body, engaging the lug and the ball pin in the recesses. Tighten the fastening nuts using a wheel bolt wrench 3. Attach the plug connector. Close and engage the flap. Self-help Picture no: 17290t.tif Hatchback 3-door 1. To replace bulbs, fold the cover down. Picture no: 17284t.tif 2. Detach plug connector from bulb holder. 3. Hold outside of bulb housing, loosen fastening nuts with wheel bolt wrench 3 and unscrew by hand. Wheel bolt wrench 3 – see vehicle tools on page 251. Picture no: 17285t.tif 279 4. Detach bulb housing towards the rear. 280 Self-help 6. Remove bulb from socket. 7. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 8. Engage bulb holder in bulb housing, ensuring that it properly engages. Picture no: 17291t.tif 5. Remove the round seal from the fastening bolt. Press the locking tabs on the outside of the bulb holder outward and remove the bulb holder. Picture no: 17287t.tif Bulbs in bulb holder: 1 = Reversing light 2 = Turn signal 3 = Tail light / brake light 4 = Tail light 5 = Fog tail light Self-help 281 11. Carry out the following steps to ensure proper function of the tail lights: – switch on ignition, – operate brake, – switch on parking lights. Picture no: 17292t.tif 9. Ensure that the bulb holder seal is positioned as illustrated. Fit the round seal on the fastening bolt. Picture no: 17289t.tif 10. Insert the bulb housing in the body, engaging the lug and the ball pin in the recesses. Tighten the fastening nuts using a wheel bolt wrench 3. Attach the plug connector. Close and engage the flap. 282 Self-help Picture no: 17293t.tif Estate 1. Disengage cover by pressing retaining lugs and remove. Picture no: 17294t.tif 2. Detach plug connector from bulb holder. 3. Hold the outside of the bulb housing, unscrew the three fastening nuts and remove the bulb housing rearwards. Picture no: 17295t.tif 4. Unscrew the three screws with a screwdriver (vehicle tools – see page 251) and remove the bulb holder. Self-help 283 6. Insert new bulb without touching the glass. Insert bulb holder in bulb housing and screw in place. Insert bulb housing into body and tighten fastening nuts by hand. Attach plug connector. Close and lock cover. 7. Carry out the following steps to ensure proper function of the tail lights: – switch on ignition, – operate brake, – switch on parking lights. Picture no: 17296t.tif Bulbs in bulb holder: 1 = Tail light / brake light 2 = Turn signal 3 = Reversing light 4 = Fog tail light 5. Remove bulb from socket. Picture no: 17986t.tif Astra TwinTop 1. Unscrew retaining nuts. 6 284 Self-help Picture no: 17987t.tif 2. Remove bulb housing from outside. Disengage plug by pressing on flap and remove from bulb holder. 3. Detach seal from bulb holder. Picture no: 17988t.tif 4. Disengage sockets by turning and remove. Press locking tabs on the long sides of the bulb holder outwards; lift bulb holder at front end (arrow) and remove. Picture no: 17989t.tif Bulbs in bulb holder: 1 = Tail light / brake light 2 = Tail light 3 = Fog tail light 4 = Reversing light 5 = Turn signal Self-help 285 5. Remove bulb from socket. 6. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 7. Insert bulb holder in bulb housing by first inserting the lug in the front of the plug. Fold together bulb holder, ensuring that it engages properly. Insert sockets and engage by turning. Picture no: 18018t.tif 8. Fit seal on bulb holder as illustrated. Ensure that the seal is flat in the area of the screws. 9. Engage plug. Insert light housing in body, ensuring proper positioning of the ball pins in the recesses. Tighten the retaining nuts. 10. Carry out the following steps to ensure proper function of the tail lights: – switch on ignition, – operate brake, – switch on parking lights. Picture no: 17297t.tif Number plate light 1. Insert screwdriver vertically in bulb insert as illustrated above. Press to the side and release spring. 286 Self-help Picture no: 17298t.tif Picture no: 17299t.tif 2. Remove bulb housing downward, taking care not to pull on the cable. 4. Rotate bulb socket anticlockwise and disengage. 3. Lift flap and disconnect plug from bulb socket. 5. Remove bulb from socket. 6. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 7. Insert socket in bulb housing and rotate clockwise to engage. 8. Connect plug to bulb socket. 9. Insert and engage bulb housing. Picture no: 17300t.tif Courtesy lights Front courtesy light, reading lights 3 To ensure that no power is supplied to the lights, close the doors before removing. 1. Disengage lens by hand at location illustrated above, press it downward slightly and remove at a downward angle. 2. Remove bulb from socket. 3. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 4. Mount lens and engage in position. Self-help 287 Rear courtesy lights 3, rear reading lights 3 Have the bulbs replaced by a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Picture no: 17301t.tif Glove compartment lighting, luggage compartment lighting, footwell lighting 3 To ensure that no power is supplied to the lights, close the doors or hold the contact switch depressed before removing. 1. Prise the light out with a screwdriver. Picture no: 17302t.tif 2. Press bulb slightly towards spring clip and remove. 3. Insert new bulb, without touching the glass. 4. Insert light in opening and engage in position. Instrument illumination, Information display illumination 3 Have the bulbs replaced by a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 288 If you have a problem If you have a problem The majority of areas of concern can be quickly resolved in this way. Should you wish to pursue the matter further, the Principal of the Vauxhall Authorised Repairer should be made aware of your concern. It is advisable in cases such as this to write to him to confirm your problem and the solutions that have been offered. In our experience the most common cause of all complaints is the result of misunderstanding or lack of communication between the customer and the Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. We sincerely hope you will never have cause to complain about your vehicle. However, if things do go wrong, the best course of action for you to take is to contact your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer’s Service Reception Staff and explain the difficulty you are having. We are confident they will do their utmost to resolve the problem to your complete satisfaction. Sometimes, however, despite the best of intentions of all concerned, misunderstandings can occur. If your problem has not been resolved to your satisfaction, please make an appointment to discuss the matter with the Manager of the department concerned. They will review all the facts involved. Then if it is felt some further action can be taken, the Vauxhall Authorised Repairer will be advised accordingly. In any case, your contact will be acknowledged confirming Vauxhall Motors’ position in the matter. If you are not satisfied with the outcome, you can if you wish, seek advice from an independent third party such as: You can be assured the Authorised Repairer’s Principal will only be too anxious to fully investigate your problems and correct any errors made. After all, he has a large investment in his business and is proud of his reputation and professionalism and fully realises that satisfied customers are his key to success. Automobile Association (A.A.) Fanum House, BASINGSTOKE, Hants., RG21 2EA In the unlikely event that you are still not happy with the answer your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer has given, or the action he proposes to correct the problem, you may contact the Customer Care Department1) where a team of Customer Care Consultants will spare no effort to ensure your complete satisfaction. The Customer Relations Department, Society of Motor Manufacturers and Traders Ltd. (S.M.M.T.), Forbes House, Halkin Street, LONDON, SW1X 7DS Vauxhall Motors Ltd. Customer Care, Griffin House, Osborne Road, LUTON, Beds., LU1 3YT Telephone: 01582 427200 1) Calls may be monitored and recorded for training purposes. Royal Automobile Club (R.A.C.), R.A.C. Motoring Services Ltd., 89-91 Pall Mall, LONDON, SW1Y S45 Customer Complaints Service, Scottish Motor Trade Association, (S.M.T.A.), 3 Palmerston Place, EDINBURGH, EH12 5AQ The National Conciliation Service, Retail Motor Industry Federation, 9 North Street, RUGBY, CV21 2AB If you have a problem whilst abroad: The Service Departments of Adam Opel AG and General Motors branches everywhere will provide information and assistance: If you have a problem Opel Austria Vertriebs GmbH Groß-Enzersdorfer Str. 59 1220 Vienna – Austria Tel. 00 43 1-2 88 77 444 or 00 43-1-2 88 77 0 ADAM OPEL AG Bahnhofsplatz 1 65423 Rüsselsheim – Germany Tel. 00 49-61 42-77 50 00 or 00 49-61 42-7 70 Opel Belgium N.V. Prins Boudewijnlaan 30 2550 Kontich – Belgium Tel. 00 32-34 50 63 11 General Motors Hellas S.A. 56 Kifisias Avenue & Delfon str. Amarousion 151 25 Athens – Greece Tel. 00 30-1-6 80 65 01 Opel C & S spol. s.r.o. Na Pankráci 26 140 00 Prague 4 – Czech Republic Tel. 00 420-2-61 21-88 21 General Motors Danmark Jaegersborg Alle 4 2920 Charlottenlund – Denmark Tel. 00 45-39 97 85 00 Vauxhall Motors Ltd. Customer Care Griffin House, Osborne Road Luton, Bedfordshire, LU1 3YT – England Tel. 00 44-15 82-42 72 00 General Motors Finland Oy Pajuniityntie 5 00320 Helsinki – Finland Tel. Helsinki 00 358-61 58 81 General Motors France 1 – 9, avenue du Marais Angle Quai de Bezons 95101 Argenteuil Cedex – France Tel. 00 33-1-34 26 30 00 Opel Southeast Europe Ltd. Szabadsag utca 117 2040 Budaörs – Hungary Tel. 00 36-23 446 100 General Motors India Sixth Floor, Tower A Global Business Park Mehrauli – Gurgaon Road Gurgaon 122 022, Haryana – India Tel. 00 91-124 280 3333 Opel Ireland Ltd. Opel House, Unit 60, Heather Road Sandyford, Dublin 18 – Ireland Tel. 00 353-1-216 10 00 General Motors Italia Srl Piazzale dell’Industria 40 00144 Rome – Italy Tel. 00 39-6-5 46 51 Opel Nederland B.V. Lage Mosten 49 – 63 4822 NK Breda – Netherlands Tel. 00 31-76-5 44 88 00 289 General Motors Norge AS Kjeller-Vest 6 2027 Kjeller – Norway Tel. 00 47-23 50 01 04 General Motors Poland Sp. z o. o. Domaniewska 41 06-672 Warsaw – Poland Tel. 00 48-22-606 17 00 General Motors Portugal Quinta da Fonte Edificío Fernão Magalhães, Piso 2 2780-190 Paço d’Arcos – Portugal Tel. 00 351-21 440 75 00 General Motors España S.L. Paseo de la Castellana, 91 28046 Madrid – Spain Tel. 00 34-902 25 00 25 Saab Opel Sverige AB Esbogatan 8 164 74 Kista – Sweden Tel. 00 46-8-632 85 00 General Motors Suisse S.A. Stelzenstraße 4 8152 Glattbrugg – Switzerland Tel. 00 41-44 828 28 80 Opel Türkiye Ltd. Sti. Kemalpasa yolu üzeri 35861 Torbali/Izmir – Turkey Tel. 00 90-2 32-8 53-14 53 In Albania, Bosnia-Herzegovina, Bulgaria, Croatia, Macedonia, Romania, Slovenia and Yugoslavia please contact the Opel Service Department in Budaörs – Hungary Tel. 00 36-23 446 100 290 Maintenance, inspection system Maintenance, inspection system The service interval display takes account of off-the-road periods during which the battery is disconnected. For vehicles with flexible oil change and service intervals, the length of these intervals is based on several parameters stemming from usage. For this reason, various engine-specific data is continually gathered and is used to calculate the remaining distance until the next service. Picture no: 17008t.tif A note on safety .................................. Checking and topping up fluids ......... Engine oil .............................................. Diesel fuel filter .................................... Coolant ................................................. Brake fluid ............................................ Windscreen wiper ................................ Windscreen and headlight wash systems 3................................. Battery .................................................. Protecting electronic components ..... Vehicle decommissioning.................... Vehicle recommissioning..................... 291 291 292 294 294 296 297 299 300 300 301 301 In order to guarantee economical and safe vehicle operation and to maintain the value of your vehicle, it is of vital importance that all maintenance work is carried out at the proper intervals as specified by Vauxhall. In vehicles with a fixed oil change and service interval, InSP appears in the odometer display when the ignition is switched on if the vehicle is due for service. Have service work performed within a week or 300 miles (500 km). We recommend that you contact your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. This remaining distance can be displayed with the ignition off: briefly press the trip odometer reset button, the mileage reading shows. Press the button again for around 2 seconds, InSP and the remaining distance is shown. If the remaining distance is less than 1000 miles (1500 km), InSP is displayed with a remaining distance of 600 miles (1000 km) when the ignition is switched on and off. InSP is displayed for several seconds if the remaining distance is less than 600 miles (1000 km). Have the service work that is due carried out within one week or 300 miles (500 km). Have this work carried out by a repairer, in accordance with Vauxhall Motors' recommendations, using Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories, in order to avoid invalidation of warranty claims. Maintenance, inspection system 291 Further information on maintenance and the Service Plan can be found in the Service Booklet, which is in the glove compartment. Have maintenance work, as well as repairs to the bodywork and equipment, carried out by a professional. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who is familiar with Vauxhall vehicles and in possession of the necessary special tools and the latest Service Instructions from Vauxhall. It is particularly advisable to use a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer during the warranty period to avoid invalidation of warranty claims. See the Service Booklet for further information. Separate anti-corrosion service Have this carried out every 2 years, either within the scope of a Service or separately, see Service Booklet. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer in order to avoid loss of warranty claims for rust damage. Picture no: 17304t.tif A note on safety To avoid injury from moving parts and cables conducting ignition voltage, only carry out engine compartment checks (e.g. checking brake fluid or engine oil level) when the ignition is switched off. 9 Warning The cooling fan is controlled by a thermoswitch and can therefore start unexpectedly even if the ignition is switched off. Risk of injury. Electronic ignition systems generate very high voltages. Do not touch the ignition system; high voltage can be fatal. Picture no: 17305t.tif Never carry out any repairs or adjustment and maintenance work on the vehicle yourself. This especially applies to the engine, chassis and safety parts. You may unwittingly infringe the provisions of the law and, by not performing the work properly, endanger yourself and other road users. Checking and topping up fluids To aid identification, the caps used when topping up engine oil, coolant and wash fluid as well as the oil dipstick are coloured yellow. 292 Maintenance, inspection system Picture no: 17306t.tif Engine oil Information on engine oils is found in the Service Booklet. Engine oil level and consumption Every engine consumes engine oil for technical reasons. The engine oil consumption cannot be assessed until a fairly long distance has been driven, and may be above the specified value when the vehicle is first being driven (run-in period). Frequent driving at high revs increases engine oil consumption. Picture no: 17307t.tif The engine oil level is checked automatically1) – see page 39. Before embarking on a long journey it is advisable to check the engine oil level. Picture no: 17308t.tif Checking the engine oil level, topping up engine oil The illustrations on this page indicate checks on one petrol and two diesel engines. The oil level must be checked with the vehicle on a level surface and with the engine (which must be at operating temperature) switched off. Wait at least 5 minutes before checking the level to allow the normal engine oil accumulation in the engine to drain into the oil pan. 9 Warning 9 Warning Do not allow the engine oil level to drop below the minimum level! It is the owner’s responsibility to maintain the correct level of an appropriate quality oil in the engine. 1) Not on Z 14 XEP or Z 20 LEH engine. Sales designation – see page 308. Maintenance, inspection system Picture no: 17309t.tif Picture no: 17310t.tif To check the engine oil level, insert wiped oil dipstick into handle as far as it will go. Top engine oil up if the level has dropped into the range of the top-up mark MIN. Top up with the same brand of engine oil that was used during the previous oil change, following the instructions in the Service Booklet. The engine oil level must not exceed the upper mark MAX on the dipstick. Excess engine oil must be drained off or extracted. If the engine oil level is above the MAX mark there is a risk of damage to the engine or the catalytic converter. To close, position the cap and screw it into place. Capacity between MIN and MAX marks – see pages 336, 337. Capacities – see pages 336, 337. 293 Picture no: 17311t.tif Oil change, oil filter change Change the oil at the displayed service intervals. We recommend that you use genuine Vauxhall oil filters. 9 Warning We recommend that you entrust engine oil and filter changes to a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who is familiar with legal requirements regarding disposal of used oil and oil filters and can thus help to protect both the environment and your health. 294 Maintenance, inspection system Diesel fuel filter Coolant Check fuel filter for any water residue when each engine oil change takes place. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. During operation the system is pressurised. The temperature may therefore rise briefly to over 100 °C. Illumination of A indicates water in the fuel filter 3. Have fuel filter checked at shorter intervals if the vehicle is subjected to extreme operating conditions such as high humidity (primarily in coastal areas), extremely high or low outside temperatures and substantially varying daytime and nighttime temperatures. The glycol-based coolant provides excellent corrosion protection for the heating and cooling systems as well as anti-freeze protection down to –28 °C. It remains in the cooling system throughout the year and need not be changed. Use of certain anti-freezes can lead to engine damage. We therefore recommend that you use anti-freezes that have been approved by Vauxhall. 9 Warning Anti-freeze is a danger to health; it must therefore be kept in the original container and out of the reach of children. Picture no: 17312t.tif Anti-freeze and corrosion protection Before the start of the cold weather season, have the coolant checked for correct concentration. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The amount of anti-freeze must provide protection up to approx. –28 °C. If the antifreeze concentration is too low, this reduces protection from freezing and corrosion. Top up anti-freeze if necessary. If coolant loss is topped up with water, have concentration checked and add antifreeze if necessary. Maintenance, inspection system 9 Warning Allow engine to cool down before removing coolant filler cap. Remove filler cap carefully so that pressure can escape slowly, otherwise there is a risk of scalding. Top up anti-freeze. If no anti-freeze is available, top up with clean tap water. If tap water is unavailable, distilled water can be used. Picture no: 17313t.tif Coolant level Hardly any losses occur since the cooling system is sealed and it is thus rarely necessary to top up the coolant. The coolant in the compensation tank should be slightly above the mark KALT / COLD with the cooling system cold. It rises when the engine is warm and falls again as it cools. If it drops below the marking in this case, it should be topped up to a level just above the marking. After topping up with drinking water or distilled water, check the anti-freeze level and add anti-freeze if required. Eliminate the cause of the coolant loss. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. To close, position the cap and screw it into place. 295 Coolant temperature Control indicator W illuminates when coolant temperature is too high. Check coolant level immediately: z Coolant level low: Top up coolant. Pay attention to the instructions given under "Anti-freeze and corrosion protection" and "Coolant level". Have the cause of coolant loss remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. z Coolant level OK: Have the cause of increased coolant temperature remedied. Consult a workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 296 Maintenance, inspection system Use of certain brake fluids can lead to damage or reduced braking effect. We therefore recommend that you use only high performance brake fluid approved by Vauxhall. When topping up, ensure maximum cleanliness as contamination of the brake fluid can lead to function problems in the braking system. Picture no: 17314t.tif Brake fluid Brake fluid level 9 Warning Caution – brake fluid is poisonous and corrosive. Do not allow it to come into contact with eyes, skin, fabric or painted surfaces. Direct contact could cause injury and damage. The fluid level in the reservoir must be neither higher than the MAX mark nor lower than the MIN mark. After correcting the brake fluid level, have the cause of brake fluid loss remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Brake fluid change Brake fluid is hygroscopic, i.e. it absorbs water. If the brakes become hot, such as when driving on long downhill stretches, vapour bubbles can occur in the water, which can have an extremely adverse effect on braking power (depending on the proportion of water). The fluid change intervals specified in the Service Booklet must therefore be observed. 9 Warning We recommend that you have brake fluid changed by a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will be familiar with the requirements of the law as regards disposal of brake fluid and can thus help to protect the environment and your health. Maintenance, inspection system Windscreen wiper Clear vision is essential for safe driving. Perform regular checks on the windscreen wiper and headlight wash system 3 to ensure they are operating correctly. We recommend wiper blade replacement at least once a year. If the windscreen is dirty, operate the windscreen wash system before switching on the windscreen wiper or setting the wiper to automatic operation with the rain sensor 3. This will avoid wiper blade wear. Do not switch on the windscreen wiper or set to automatic operation with the rain sensor 3 if the windscreen is iced up, as this could damage the wiper blades or the wiper system. 297 If the wiper becomes frozen on to the glass, we recommend that it be released with the aid of Vauxhall De-icer Spray before starting the vehicle, to prevent wiper motor damage. Smearing wiper blades can be cleaned with a soft cloth and Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent. Wiper blades whose lips have become hardened, cracked or covered with silicone must be replaced. This may be necessary as a result of the effects of ice, thawing salt or heat, or the incorrect use of cleaning agents. Switch off the windscreen wiper or automatic wiper with rain sensor 3 in car washes – see pages 17, 18, 303. Windscreen wiper care – see page 304. Picture no: 17315t.tif To ensure proper operation of the rain sensor 3 the sensor area must be free from dust, dirt and ice, which is why the windscreen wash system must be operated at regular intervals and the sensor area de-iced. Vehicles with rain sensor 3 can be identified by the sensor area near the top of the windscreen. 298 Maintenance, inspection system Picture no: 17316t.tif Service setting for front windscreen wiper (e.g. for changing or cleaning the front wiper blades). Within 4 seconds of switching off the engine but with the key in the starter switch, press the windscreen wiper stalk downward. Release the stalk as soon as the wiper blades are vertical. Picture no: 17317t.tif Wiper blades on the windscreen Activate service setting - see previous column. Raise wiper arm, tilt wiper blade at a 90° to the wiper arm and remove to the side. Picture no: 17318t.tif Wiper blade on the rear window 3 Lift wiper arm. Disengage wiper blade as shown in illustration and remove. Maintenance, inspection system The windscreen wash system and headlight wash system will not freeze in winter: Frost protection down to – 5 °C – 10 °C – 20 °C – 30 °C Picture no: 17319t.tif Windscreen and headlight wash systems 3 The fluid reservoir filler neck for the windscreen wash system and headlight wash system 3 is located at the front next to the left headlight. Capacities – see pages 336, 337. Fill only with clean water to prevent the nozzles from clogging. To improve cleaning efficiency, we recommend that you add a little Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent. Mixture Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent : Water 1:3 1:2 1:1 2:1 When closing the reservoir, press the lid firmly over the beaded edge all the way round. 299 300 Maintenance, inspection system Laying up the vehicle for more than 4 weeks can lead to battery discharge, which may reduce the service life of the battery. Disconnect battery from on-board power supply by detaching negative terminal (Vauxhall alarm system 3 is then disabled). Protecting electronic components Ensure that ignition is switched off before connecting battery. Then perform the following actions: To avoid damaging the vehicle, do not make any modifications to the electrical system, e. g. connecting additional consumers or tampering with electronic control units (chip tuning). z Setting date and time in the information display – see pages 48, 51, 56. Battery Picture no: 17320t.tif The battery is maintenance-free. 9 Warning We recommend that you have battery changes carried out by a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. A Vauxhall Authorised Repairer knows the laws concerning the disposal of used batteries and therefore protects the environment and your health. Retro-fitted electrical or electronic accessories can place an additional load on the battery or even discharge the battery. We recommend that you consult a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer regarding technical possibilities, such as fitting a more powerful battery. z If necessary activate the windows 3 and sunroof 3 – see pages 143, 144. In order to prevent the battery from discharging, some consumers such as the courtesy light automatically switch off after approx. 20 minutes. In order to prevent faults in electronic components in the electrical system, never connect or disconnect battery with engine running or ignition switched on. Never start engine with battery disconnected, e.g. when starting using jump leads. 9 Warning Electronic ignition systems generate very high voltages. Do not touch the ignition system; high voltage can be fatal. Disconnecting / connecting the battery from / to the electrical system Disconnect the battery from the vehicle electrical system before charging: First detach the negative and then the positive lead. Do not reverse the polarity of the battery, i.e. do not confuse the terminals for the positive and negative leads. When connecting, start with the positive lead and then connect the negative lead. Maintenance, inspection system Vehicle decommissioning Observe national regulations. If the vehicle is decommissioned for several months, the following work must be carried out in order to prevent damage. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. z Wash and preserve the vehicle – see page 303. z Check preservation in engine compartment and on underbody and rectify where necessary. z Clean and wax the rubber seals of the bonnet, doors and roof. Intermediate roof position for cleaning – see page 149. z Change engine oil – see page 293. z Check anti-freeze and corrosion protection – see page 294. z Check the coolant level, top up with anti-freeze if necessary – see page 295. z Empty windscreen wash system and headlight wash system. z Increase tyre pressure to value specified for full load – see page 327. Vehicle storage z Park vehicle in dry, well ventilated place. With manual transmission or Easytronic 3, engage 1st or reverse gear. With automatic transmission 3, selector lever in P. Use chocks or the like to prevent the vehicle from rolling. 301 Vehicle recommissioning Observe national regulations. Perform the following work before recommissioning the vehicle: z Connect battery – see page 300. z Do not apply handbrake. z Check tyre pressure and correct if necessary – see page 327. z Disconnect battery by disengaging negative terminal from vehicle electrical system – see page 300. z Fill up windscreen wash system – see page 299. z Check engine oil level – see page 292. z Check the coolant level; top up with anti-freeze if necessary – see page 295. z Fit the number plate if necessary. 302 Vehicle care Vehicle care Obtain advice from a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer regarding cleaning materials that have been tested and recommended by Vauxhall. When caring for your vehicle, observe all national environmental regulations, particularly when washing it. Vehicle care aids 3.............................. Washing ............................................... Waxing ................................................. Polishing ............................................... Wheels .................................................. Paintwork damage .............................. Exterior lights ....................................... Exterior lights ....................................... Plastic and rubber parts ..................... Wheels and tyres ................................. Interior and upholstery........................ Seat belts.............................................. Windows ............................................... Windscreen wiper blades .................... Locks..................................................... Engine compartment........................... Underbody ........................................... Astra TwinTop ..................................... 302 303 303 303 303 304 304 304 304 304 304 304 304 304 305 305 305 305 Regular, thorough care helps to improve the appearance of your vehicle and maintain its value over the years. It is also a prerequisite for warranty claims for any paint or corrosion damage. The following pages contain tips for vehicle care which, if used properly, will help combat the unavoidable, damaging effects of the environment. Vehicle care aids 3 Vehicle wash: z Wash brush, z Car Shampoo, z Car Sponges, z Insect Removal Sponge, z Wheel Cleaners, z Engine Cleaners, z Glass Cleaners, z Chamois Leather. Vehicle care: z Paintwork Cleaner, z Paintwork Polish, z Cream Polish, z Metallic Paintwork Wax, z Hard wax, z Vauxhall Touch-Up Paint, z Vauxhall Touch-Up / Aerosol Paint, z Wheel Preserver, z Insect Remover, z Window Cleaning Spray, z Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent, z Silicone Oil for Rubber Seals, z Rust Preventative, z Alloy Wheel Cleaner, z Cleaner. Vehicle care Washing The paintwork of your vehicle is exposed to environmental influences, e.g. continuous changes in weather conditions, industrial waste gases and dust or thawing salts, so wash and wax your vehicle regularly. When using automatic car washes, select a programme which includes waxing. Bird droppings, dead insects, resin, pollen and the like should be cleaned off immediately, as they contain aggressive constituents which can cause paint damage. If using a car wash, comply with the pertinent instructions of the car wash manufacturer. The windscreen wiper and rear window wiper must be switched off – see pages 17, 18. Remove antenna 3 and roof rack 3. Stand on the door sill to reach them more easily. If you wash your vehicle by hand, make sure that the insides of the wings are also thoroughly rinsed out. Clean edges and folds on opened doors and flaps as well as the areas they cover. Thoroughly rinse off and leather-off the vehicle. Rinse leather frequently. Use separate leathers for paint and window surfaces: remnants of wax on the windows will impair vision. Observe national regulations. Waxing Wax your vehicle regularly, in particular after it has been washed using shampoo and at the latest when water no longer forms beads on the paintwork, otherwise the paintwork will dry out. Also wax edges and folds on opened doors and flaps as well as the areas they cover. 303 Polishing Polishing is necessary only if the paint has become dull or if solid deposits have become attached to it. Paintwork polish with silicone forms a protective film, making waxing unnecessary. Plastic body parts should not be treated with wax and polish. Use Metallic Paintwork Wax on vehicles with a metallic-effect paint finish. Wheels Use a pH-neutral wheel cleaning agent to clean the wheels. Wheels are painted and can be treated with the same agents as the body. For alloy wheels we recommend use of Alloy Wheel Preserver. 304 Vehicle care Paintwork damage Plastic and rubber parts Repair small areas of paint damage such as stone impacts, scratches etc. immediately using a Vauxhall touch-up applicator or Vauxhall spray and touch-up paint before rust can form. If rust has already formed, have the cause remedied. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Please also pay attention to surfaces and edges beneath the vehicle where rust may have formed unnoticed for some time. For additional cleaning of plastic and rubber parts use Cleaner. Do not use any other agent, and in particular do not use solvents or petrol. Exterior lights Headlight and other protective light bezels are made of plastic. If they require additional cleaning after the vehicle has been washed, clean them with Car Shampoo. Do not use any abrasive or caustic agents, do not use an ice scraper, and do not clean them dry. Wheels and tyres Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners. Interior and upholstery Clean the vehicle interior, including the instrument panel facia, using interior cleaner. The instrument panel should only be cleaned using a soft damp cloth. Clean fabric upholstery with a vacuum cleaner and brush. To remove stains, use cleaner that is suitable for both fabrics and vinyl. Do not use cleaning agents such as acetone, tetrachloride, paint thinner, pint remover, nail varnish remover, washing powder or bleach. Petrol is also unsuitable. Open Velcro fasteners on clothing could damage seat upholstery. Make sure Velcro fasteners are closed. Seat belts Always keep seat belts clean and dry. Clean only with lukewarm water or Cleaner. Windows When cleaning the heated rear window, make sure that the heating element on the inside of the window is not damaged. Use a soft lint-free cloth or chamois leather in conjunction with Window Cleaner and Insect Remover. Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent is suitable for de-icing windows. For mechanical removal of ice, use a commercially available sharp-edged ice scraper. Press the scraper firmly against the glass so that no dirt can get under it and scratch the glass. Windscreen wiper blades Wax, such as that used in car washes, can cause streaks to form on the windscreen when the wiper is used. Vehicle care Smearing wiper blades can be cleaned with a soft cloth and Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent, and replaced if necessary – see page 297. Locks The locks are lubricated with a high-grade lock cylinder grease at the factory. Vauxhall lock cylinder grease prevents the locks from freezing up. Only use de-icing agent in emergencies, as they have a degreasing effect and will impair the function of the locks. After using a de-icing agent, have the locks re-greased. We recommend that you entrust this to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Engine compartment Areas of the engine compartment that are painted in the same colour as the vehicle must be looked after like any other painted surface. It is advisable to wash the engine compartment before and after winter and preserve it with wax. Cover alternator and brake fluid reservoir with plastic sheets before washing the engine. When washing the engine with a steam-jet cleaner, do not direct the steam jet at components of the Anti-lock Brake System (ABS), the air conditioning system, the climate control system or the belt drive and its components. Protective wax that has been applied is also removed during the engine wash. For this reason, have the engine, brake system components in the engine compartment, axle components with steering, body parts and cavities thoroughly preserved with protective wax after the wash. We recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. An engine wash can be performed in the spring in order to remove dirt that has adhered to the engine compartment, which may also have a high salt content. Check protective wax layer and make good if necessary. Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners. Underbody Your vehicle has a factory-applied PVC undercoating in the wheel arches (including the longitudinal members) which provides permanent protection and needs no special maintenance. The surfaces of the vehicle underbody not covered by PVC are provided with a durable protective wax coating in critical areas. On vehicles which are washed frequently in automatic car washes with underbody washing facility, the protective wax coating may be impaired by dirt-dissolving additives. 305 Check the underbody after washing and have it waxed if necessary. Before the start of the cold weather season, check the PVC coating and protective wax coating. Have them restored to perfect condition if necessary. Caution - commercially available bitumen / rubber materials can damage the PVC coating. We recommend that you have underbody work carried out by a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who knows the prescribed materials and has experience in the use thereof. The underbody should be washed following the end of the cold weather season to remove any dirt adhering to the underbody since this may also contain salt. Check protective wax coating and, if necessary, have it restored to perfect condition. Astra TwinTop Treat all seals, e.g. on the roof and windscreen frame, with silicone oil from time to time. Good contact between the fine rubber lips and the sealing surfaces prevents leaks and reduces clamping forces. Intermediate roof position for cleaning – see page 149. Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners. 306 Technical data Technical data Vehicle documents, identification plate............................ Vehicle identification data.................. Coolant, brake fluid, oils ..................... Engine data.......................................... Performance......................................... Fuel consumption, CO2 emissions ...... Weights, payload and roof load ........ Tyres ..................................................... Electrical system .................................. Capacities ............................................ Dimensions ........................................... Installation dimensions of trailer towing equipment............................. Picture no: 17321t.tif 306 307 307 308 310 313 318 326 335 336 338 339 Vehicle documents, identification plate The technical data is determined in accordance with European Community standards. We reserve the right to make modifications. Specifications in the vehicle documents always have priority over those given in this manual. The identification plate is affixed to the front right door frame. Picture no: 17322t.tif Information on identification plate: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Manufacturer Type approval number Vehicle Identification Number Permissible Gross Vehicle Weight Permissible Gross Train Weight Maximum permissible front axle load Maximum permissible rear axle load Vehicle-specific or country-specific data Technical data 307 Coolant, brake fluid, oils When topping up – coolant, – brake fluid, – manual transmission oil, – automatic transmission oil, – power steering oil, we recommend that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who can advise you on the correct products to use. Use of unsuitable fluids can cause serious damage to the vehicle. Picture no: 17323t.tif Vehicle identification data The Vehicle Identification Number is stamped on the identification plate (see previous page) and in the vehicle floor on the right-hand side under a cover between the driver’s door and seat. Picture no: 17324t.tif The Vehicle Identification Number may be embossed on the instrument panel. Engine code and engine number: stamped on left-hand side of engine on crankcase. Engine oils Information on engine oils is found in the Service Booklet. 308 Technical data Engine data Sales designation Engine identifier code 1.4 Z 14 XEP 1.6 Z 16 XEP 1.8 Z 18 XE 2.0 Turbo Z 20 LEL 2.0 Turbo Z 20 LER Number of cylinders 4 4 4 4 4 Bore dia. (mm) 73.4 79.0 80.5 86.0 86.0 80.6 81.5 88.2 86.0 86.0 Piston displacement (cm ) 1364 1598 1796 1998 1998 Brake horse power (kW) at rpm 66 5600 77 6000 92 5600 125 5200 147 5400 Torque (Nm) at rpm 125 4000 150 3900 170 3800 250 1950 262 4200 10.5 10.5 10.5 8.8 8.8 95 2) 98 2)) 91 2)3) 95 2) 98 2) 91 2)3) 95 2) 98 2) 91 2) 95 2) 98 2) 91 2)4) 95 2) 98 2) 91 2)4) Max. permissible engine speed, continuous operation (rpm) approx. 6200 6400 6400 6400 6400 Oil consumption (l/1000 km) 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 Stroke (mm) 3 Compression ratio Octane requirement (RON) unleaded or unleaded or unleaded 1) 2) 3) 4) 1) 0.6 Standard high-quality fuels, e.g. unleaded DIN EN 228; value printed in bold: recommended fuel. Knock control system automatically adjusts ignition timing according to type of fuel used (octane number). Use of 91 RON fuel reduces power and torque. If no unleaded Premium fuel is available, 91 RON can be used taking care to avoid high engine load or full load as well as for driving in mountainous terrain with a caravan / trailer load or high payload. Technical data Engine data Sales designation Engine identifier code VXR Z 20 LEH 1.3 CDTI Z 13 DTH 1.7 CDTI Z 17 DTH 1.9 CDTI Z 19 DT 1.9 CDTI Z 19 DTH Number of cylinders 4 4 4 4 4 Bore dia. (mm) 86.0 69.6 79.0 82.0 82.0 86.0 82.0 86.0 90.4 90.4 Piston displacement (cm ) 1998 1248 1686 1910 1910 Brake horse power (kW) at rpm 177 5600 66 4000 74 4400 88 3250 110 4000 Torque (Nm) at rpm 320 2400 to 5000 200 1750 to 2500 240 2300 280 1750 to 2750 320 2000 to 2750 8.8 18.0 18.4 18.0 17.5 95 2)3) 98 2) 91 2)4) – – – – 49 (D)5) – – – 49 (D)5) – – – 49 (D)5) – – – 49 (D)5) Max. permissible engine speed, continuous operation (rpm) approx. 6400 5100 to 5300 5200 5200 5200 Oil consumption (l/1000 km) 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 Stroke (mm) 3 Compression ratio Octane requirement (RON) unleaded or unleaded or unleaded Cetane requirement (CN)1) 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 1) 0.6 Standard high-quality fuels, e.g. unleaded DIN EN 228, Diesel DIN EN 590; D = Diesel; value printed in bold: recommended fuel. Knock control system automatically adjusts ignition timing according to type of fuel used (octane number). Use of 95 RON fuel reduces power and torque. Slight increase in fuel consumption. If no unleaded Premium fuel is available, 91 RON can be used taking care to avoid high engine load or full load as well as for driving in mountainous terrain with a caravan / trailer load or high payload. A lower value is possible with winter diesel fuels. 309 310 Technical data Performance (approx. mph / km/h), 5-door Engine 1) Hatchback Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER 111/178 110/176 – 115/185 115/185 – 123/198 – 117/188 135/217 – – 143/230 – – Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH 107/172 – 3) – 112/180 – – 121/194 – 117/188 129/208 – – 2) Maximum speed Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission Engine1) 2) Maximum speed Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission 1) 2) 3) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. The maximum speed indicated is achievable at kerbweight (without driver) plus 200 kg payload. Optional equipment could reduce the specified maximum speed of the vehicle. Value not available at time of printing. Technical data Performance (approx. mph / km/h), 3-door 1) Hatchback Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Maximum speed Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission 112/180 111/178 – 116/187 116/187 – 124/200 – 118/190 137/220 – – 145/234 – – Engine1) Z 20 LEH VXR Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH 152/244 – – 108/174 –3) – 113/182 – – 122/196 – 118/190 130/210 – – Engine 2) 2) Maximum speed Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission 1) 2) 3) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. The maximum speed indicated is achievable at kerbweight (without driver) plus 200 kg payload. Optional equipment could reduce the specified maximum speed of the vehicle. Value not available at time of printing. 311 312 Technical data Performance (approx. mph / km/h), Engine Estate 1) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER 111/178 – – 115/185 115/185 – 123/198 – 115/188 135/217 – – 143/230 – – Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH 107/172 – – 112/180 – – 120/193 – 116/187 129/207 – – 2) Maximum speed Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission Engine1) 2) Maximum speed Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission Performance (approx. mph / km/h), TwinTop Engine Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Z 19 DTH Maximum speed2) Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission 116/186 – – –3) – – 139/224 – – 147/237 – – 132/213 – – 1) 2) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. The maximum speed indicated is achievable at kerbweight (without driver) plus 200 kg payload. Optional equipment could reduce the specified maximum speed of the vehicle. 3) Value not available at time of printing. Technical data Fuel consumption, CO2 emissions Directive 80/1268/EEC (last changed by 1999/100/EC) has applied for the measurement of fuel consumption since 1996. The directive is oriented to actual driving practices: Urban driving is rated at approx. 1/3 and extra-urban driving with approx. 2/3 (urban and extra-urban consumption). Cold starts and acceleration phases are also taken into consideration. The specification of CO2 emission is also a constituent of the directive. 313 The figures given must not be taken as a guarantee for the actual fuel consumption of a particular vehicle. All values are based on the EU base model with standard equipment. The calculation of fuel consumption as specified by directive 1999/100/EC takes account of the vehicle’s kerbweight, ascertained in accordance with these regulations. Optional extras may result in slightly higher fuel consumption and CO2 emission levels than those quoted. To convert 1/100 km into mpg, divide 282 by number of litres/100 km. Saving fuel, protecting the environment – see page 198. 314 Technical data Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km), CO2 emissions (approx. g/km), Hatchback 5-door (tyre width up to 205 mm1)) Engine2) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission 8.2/ 7.7/– urban 5.2/ 4.9/– extra-urban 6.3/ 5.9/– total 151/142/– CO2 8.6/ 8.5/– 5.4/ 5.3/– 6.6/ 6.5/– 158/156/– 10.4/–/11.4 6.1/–/ 6.3 7.7/–/ 8.2 185/–/197 –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– Engine2) Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 6.2/–3)/– 4.0/– /– 4.8/– /– 130/– /– 6.4/–/– 4.2/–/– 5.0/–/– 135/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km), CO2 emissions (approx. g/km), Hatchback 5-door (tyre width up to 225 mm) Engine2) Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission 8.4/ 7.9/– urban 5.4/ 5.1/– extra-urban 6.5/ 6.1/– total 156/146/– CO2 8.8/ 8.7/– 5.6/ 5.5/– 6.8/ 6.7/– 163/161/– 10.6/–/11.6 6.3/–/ 6.5 7.9/–/ 8.4 190/–/202 12.8/–/– 6.8/–/– 9.0/–/– 216/–/– 13.1/–/– 7.1/–/– 9.3/–/– 223/–/– Engine2) Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 –/–3)/– –/– /– –/– /– –/– /– 6.5/–/– 4.3/–/– 5.1/–/– 138/–/– 7.7/–/ 9.8 5.0/–/ 5.5 6.0/–/ 7.1 162/–/192 7.4/–/– 4.9/–/– 5.8/–/– 157/–/– 1) 2) 3) For Z 17 DTH engine – tyre width up to 195 mm. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Values not available at time of printing. Z 14 XEP Technical data Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km), CO2 emissions (approx. g/km), Hatchback 3-door (tyre width up to 205 mm1)) Engine2) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 8.2/ 7.7/– 5.2/ 4.9/– 6.3/ 5.9/– 151/142/– 8.6/ 8.5/– 5.4/ 5.3/– 6.6/ 6.5/– 158/156/– 10.4/–/11.3 6.1/–/ 6.2 7.7/–/ 8.1 185/–/194 –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– Engine2) Z 20 LEH VXR Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– 6.4/–/– 4.2/–/– 5.0/–/– 135/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– 6.2/–3)/– 4.0/– /– 4.8/– /– 130/– /– Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km), CO2 emissions (approx. g/km), Hatchback 3-door (tyre width up to 225 mm4)) Engine2) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 8.4/ 7.9/– 5.4/ 5.1/– 6.5/ 6.1/– 156/146/– 8.8/ 8.7/– 5.6/ 5.5/– 6.8/ 6.7/– 163/161/– 10.6/–/11.5 6.3/–/ 6.4 7.9/–/ 8.3 190/–/199 12.8/–/– 6.8/–/– 9.0/–/– 216/–/– 13.1/–/– 7.1/–/– 9.3/–/– 223/–/– Engine2) Z 20 LEH VXR Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH 6.5/–/– 4.3/–/– 5.1/–/– 138/–/– 7.7/–/ 9.7 5.0/–/ 5.4 6.0/–/ 7.0 162/–/189 7.4/–/– 4.9/–/– 5.8/–/– 157/–/– Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission 13.0/–/– urban 7.0/–/– extra-urban 9.2/–/– total 221/–/– CO2 1) 2) 3) 4) For Z 17 DTH engine – tyre width up to 195 mm. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Values not available at time of printing. For Z 20 LEH engine – tyre width up to 235 mm. –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– 315 316 Technical data Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km), CO2 emissions (approx. g/km), Estate (tyre width up to 205 mm1)) Engine2) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 8.2/–/– 5.2/–/– 6.3/–/– 151/–/– 8.7/ 8.6/– 5.5/ 5.4/– 6.7/ 6.6/– 161/158/– 10.5/–/11.4 6.2/–/ 6.3 7.8/–/ 8.2 187/–/197 –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– Engine2) Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 6.2/–/– 4.0/–/– 4.8/–/– 130/–/– 6.4/–/– 4.2/–/– 5.0/–/– 135/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km), CO2 emissions (approx. g/km), Estate (tyre width up to 225 mm) Engine2) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 8.4/–/– 5.4/–/– 6.5/–/– 156/–/– 8.9/ 8.8/– 5.7/ 5.6/– 6.9/ 6.8/– 166/163/– 10.7/–/11.6 6.4/–/ 6.5 8.0/–/ 8.4 192/–/202 12.9/–/– 6.9/–/– 9.1/–/– 218/–/– 13.2/–/– 7.2/–/– 9.4/–/– 226/–/– Engine2) Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– –/–/– 6.5/–/– 4.3/–/– 5.1/–/– 138/–/– 7.8/–/ 9.8 5.1/–/ 5.5 6.1/–/ 7.1 165/–/192 7.5/–/– 5.0/–/– 5.9/–/– 159/–/– 1) 2) For Z 17 DTH engine - tyre width up to 195 mm. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Technical data 317 Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km), CO2 emissions (approx. g/km), TwinTop (tyre width up to 225 mm) Engine1) Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Z 19 DTH Manual transmission/Easytronic/Automatic transmission urban extra-urban total CO2 9.1/–/– 5.8/–/– 7.0/–/– 168/–/– –2) –2) –2) –2) 13.0/–/– 7.0/–/– 9.2/–/– 221/–/– 13.3/–/– 7.3/–/– 9.5/–/– 228/–/– 7.7/–/– 5.2/–/– 6.1/–/– 165/–/– 1) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. 2) Value not available at time of printing. 318 Technical data Weights, payload and roof load The payload is the difference between the permitted Gross Vehicle Weight (see identification plate on page 306) and the EC kerbweight. To calculate the kerbweight, enter the data for your vehicle below: z Kerbweight from Table 1, page 319 + .............. kg z Additional weight of equipment versions from Table 2, page 323 + .............. kg z Weight of heavy accessories from Table 3, page 325 + .............. kg The total = .............. kg is the EC kerbweight. Optional equipment and accessories increase the kerbweight, which means that the payload will also change slightly. Note the weights given in the vehicle documents. The combined total of front and rear axle loads must not exceed the permissible Gross Vehicle Weight. For example, if the front axle is bearing its maximum permissible load, the rear axle can only bear a load that is equal to the Gross Vehicle Weight minus the front axle load. Roof load The permissible roof load is 75 kg and 100 kg for caravan with roof railing. The roof load is the combined weight of the roof rack and the load. With a trailer coupled and the towing vehicle fully loaded (including all occupants) the permissible rear axle load (see identification plate or vehicle documents) may be exceeded by 65 kg and permissible Gross Vehicle Weight by 45 kg for the Hatchback. For the Estate, the permissible rear axle load may be exceeded by 60 kg and the permissible Gross Vehicle Weight by 30 kg. If the permissible rear axle load is exceeded, a maximum speed of 60 mph (100 km/h) applies. If national regulations specify a lower maximum speed for vehicles towing a trailer, this must be observed. Driving hints – see page 196. Roof racks, caravan and trailer towing – see page 234. See the identification plate or vehicle documents for permissible axle loads. Roof loads are not permitted on the Astra TwinTop. Technical data Weight (kg), Table 1, Kerbweight1), Hatchback 5-door Model Engine2) Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission Astra Z 14 XEP 1230 1230 – Z 16 XEP 1265 1265 – Z 18 XE 1278 – 1310 Z 13 DTH 1330 – – Z 17 DTH 1365 – – Z 19 DT 1395 – 1425 Z 19 DTH 1393 – – Z 14 XEP 1250 1250 – Z 16 XEP 1285 1285 – Z 18 XE 1298 – 1330 Z 20 LEL 1385 – – Z 20 LER 1385 – – Z 13 DTH 1345 – – Z 17 DTH 1380 – – Z 19 DT 1410 – 1440 Z 19 DTH 1408 – – Astra with air conditioning system or Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 1) 2) According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full). Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. 319 320 Technical data Weight (kg), Table 1, Kerbweight1), Hatchback 3-door Model Engine2) Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission Astra Z 14 XEP 1210 – – Z 16 XEP 1245 1245 – Z 18 XE 1265 – 1297 Z 13 DTH 1310 – – Z 17 DTH 1345 – – Z 19 DT 1370 – 1393 Z 19 DTH 1390 – – Z 14 XEP 1230 – – Z 16 XEP 1265 1265 – Astra with air conditioning system or Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 1) 2) Z 18 XE 1285 – 1317 Z 20 LEL 1365 – – Z 20 LER 1365 – – Z 20 LEH VXR 1393 – – Z 13 DTH 1325 – – Z 17 DTH 1360 – – Z 19 DT 1385 – 1408 Z 19 DTH 1405 – – According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full). Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Technical data Weights (kg), Table 1, Kerbweight1), Estate Model Engine2) Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission Astra Z 14 XEP 1280 – – Z 16 XEP 1315 1315 – Z 18 XE 1325 – 1350 Z 13 DTH 1380 – – Z 17 DTH 1393 – – Z 19 DT 1435 – 1465 Z 19 DTH 1450 – – Z 14 XEP 1300 – – Z 16 XEP 1335 1335 – Astra with air conditioning system or Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 1) 2) Z 18 XE 1345 – 1370 Z 20 LEL 1425 – – Z 20 LER 1425 – – Z 13 DTH 1395 – – Z 17 DTH 1408 – – Z 19 DT 1450 – 1480 Z 19 DTH 1465 – – According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full). Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. 321 322 Technical data Weights (kg), Table 1, Kerbweight1), TwinTop Model Engine2) Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic transmission Astra Z 16 XEP 1495 – – Z 18 XE 1500 – – Z 19 DTH 1613 – – Z 16 XEP 1515 – – Z 18 XE 1520 – – Z 20 LEL 1605 – – Astra with air conditioning system or Electronic Climate Control (ECC) 1) 2) Z 20 LER 1605 – – Z 19 DTH 1628 – – According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full). Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Technical data Weights (kg), Table 2, Additional weight of equipment versions Hatchback Engine1) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Life, Club 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9 Design 12 12 12 12 12 SXi, SRi 24.5 24.5 24.5 12.6 12.6 Elite 22.8 22.8 22.8 9.3 9.3 Engine1) Z 20 LEH VXR Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH Life, Club – 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9 Design – 12 12 12 12 SXi, SRi – 24.5 24.5 24.5 12.6 Elite – 22.8 22.8 22.8 9.3 1) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. 323 324 Technical data Weights (kg), Table 2, Additional weight of equipment versions Estate Engine1) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Life, Club 7.4 7.4 7.4 3 Design 13 13 13 9 SXi, SRi 9 9 9 7.3 Elite 9 9 9 5 Engine1) Z 20 LER Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH Life, Club 3 7.4 3 3 Design 9 13 9 9 SXi, SRi 7.3 9 7.3 7.3 Elite 5 9 5 5 1) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Technical data Weights (kg), Table 2, Additional weight of equipment versions TwinTop Engine1) Z 16 XEP 2) Life, Club – Design –2) Z 18 XE – 2) –2) Z 20 LEL 2) Z 20 LER Z 19 DTH – – 2) –2) –2) –2) –2) Weights (kg), Table 3, Heavy accessories Accessories Sunroof Towing equipment Split rear seat bench Weight 25 (Hatchback 5-door, Estate) 23 (Hatchback 3-door) 22 (Hatchback 5-door, Estate) 20 (Hatchback 3-door) 10 (Hatchback 5-door) 20 (Estate) 9 (Hatchback 3-door) 1) 2) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Value not available at time of printing. 325 326 Technical data Tyres Tyre chains 3 Restrictions Not all tyres available on the market currently meet the structural requirements. We recommend that you consult a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer concerning suitable tyre makes. Restrictions Tyre chains may be used on the front wheels only. These tyres have undergone special tests to establish their reliability, safety and specific suitability for Vauxhall vehicles. Despite continuous market monitoring, we are unable to assess these attributes for other tyres, even if they have been granted approval by the relevant authorities or in some other form. Further information – see page 226. Winter tyres 3 Tyres of size 215/45 R 17, 225/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 or 235/35 R 19 are not to be used as winter tyres. Tyres of size 225/45 R 17 may be used as winter tyres on the Astra TwinTop. If winter tyres are in use, the spare wheel may still be fitted with a summer tyre. Use of the spare wheel may alter vehicle handling. Obtain a replacement for the faulty tyre as soon as possible, and have the wheel balanced and fitted to the vehicle. We recommend the use of Vauxhall-tested fine-mesh tyre chains that add no more than 10 mm to the tyre tread and the inboard sides (including chain lock). Tyre chains are not permitted on temporary spare wheel 115/70 R 16 or on tyres of size 215/45 R 17, 225/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 or 235/35 R 19. Tyre chains are permitted on tyres of size 225/45 R 17 for the Astra TwinTop. Further information – see page 232. Wheels Wheel bolt tightening torque: 110 Nm. Depending on the model variant, the spare wheel may take the form of a temporary spare wheel: vehicle driveability may be altered by use of the spare wheel. Obtain a replacement for the faulty tyre as soon as possible, and have the wheel balanced and fitted to the vehicle. The spare wheel may have a smaller tyre and a smaller rim than the wheels mounted on the vehicle1): Using the spare wheel may alter vehicle handling. Have the defective tyre replaced as soon as possible, balance the wheel and have it mounted on the vehicle. Tyre pressure in bar / psi2) The specified tyre pressures are valid for cold tyres. The increased tyre pressure resulting from extensive driving must not be reduced. The tyre pressures specified on the following pages apply to both summer and winter tyres. Always inflate the spare wheel to the tyre pressure for full load - see tables on following pages. Temporary spare wheel tyre pressure see tables on next page. In vehicles with tyre pressure monitoring system 3 there is an adapter in the valve cap key. Screw adapter to valve before attaching tyre pressure gauge – see page 228. Further information – see pages 226 to 233. Further information – see page 232. 1) 2) Country-specific version: The spare wheel is only to be used as a temporary spare wheel. 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. Technical data (ctd.) Tyre pressure in bar / psi1) Hatchback Tyre pressure for load of up to 3 persons Tyre pressure ECO2) Tyre pressure loaded up to for full load 3 people Engine3) Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear Z 14 XEP, 185/65 R 15, Z 16 XEP, 195/60 R 15, Z 18 XE 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.3/33 2.1/30 – – 2.5/36 2.9/42 195/65 R 15, 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 1.9/28 1.9/28 2.4/35 2.4/35 2.0/29 2.5/36 Z 20 LEL 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.5/36 2.3/33 – – 2.6/38 3.0/44 T 115/70 R 16 4.2/61 (temporary spare)4) 4.2/61 – – 4.2/61 4.2/61 all 1) 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. 327 2) 3) 4) Tyres To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. 328 Technical data (ctd.) Tyre pressure in bar / psi1) 1) 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. Hatchback Tyre pressure for load of up to 3 persons Tyre pressure ECO2) loaded up to 3 people Tyre pressure for full load Engine3) Tyres Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear Z 20 LER 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.6/38 2.4/35 – – 2.7/39 3.1/45 Z 20 LEH (VXR) 205/50 R 17, 225/40 R 18, 235/35 R 19 2.4/35 2.4/35 – – 2.5/36 2.9/42 all 4.2/61 T 115/70 R 16 (temporary spare)4) 4.2/61 – – 4.2/61 4.2/61 2) 3) 4) To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. Technical data (ctd.) Tyre pressure in bar / psi1) Hatchback 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. Tyre pressure for load of up to 3 persons Tyre pressure ECO2) loaded up to 3 people Tyre pressure for full load Engine3) Tyres Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear Z 13 DTH 185/65 R 15, 195/60 R 15 2.3/33 2.1/30 – – 2.5/36 2.9/42 195/65 R 15, 205/55 R 16 2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 4.2/61 T 115/70 R 16 (temporary spare)4) 4.2/61 – – 4.2/61 4.2/61 all 1) 329 2) 3) 4) To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. 330 Technical data (ctd.) Tyre pressure in bar / psi1) Hatchback Tyre pressure for full load Tyres Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear Z 17 DTH 195/65 R 15, 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.5/36 2.3/33 – – 2.6/38 3.0/44 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.6/38 2.4/35 – – 2.7/39 3.1/45 4.2/61 T 115/70 R 16 (temporary spare)4) 4.2/61 – – 4.2/61 4.2/61 all 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. Tyre pressure ECO2) loaded up to 3 people Engine3) Z 19 DT, Z 19 DTH 1) Tyre pressure for load of up to 3 persons 2) 3) 4) To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. Technical data (ctd.) Tyre pressure in bar / psi1) Estate Tyre pressure ECO2) loaded up to 3 people Tyre pressure for full load Tyres Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear Z 14 XEP, Z 16 XEP, Z 18 XE 195/65 R 15, 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.0/29 2.0/29 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.1/30 2.6/38 185/65 R 15, 195/60 R 15, 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.3/33 2.1/30 – – 2.5/36 2.9/42 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.5/36 2.3/33 – – 2.6/38 3.0/44 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.7/39 2.5/36 – – 2.8/41 3.1/45 4.2/61 T 115/70 R 16 (temporary spare)4) 4.2/61 – – 4.2/61 4.2/61 Z 20 LER all 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. Tyre pressure for load of up to 3 persons Engine3) Z 20 LEL 1) 331 2) 3) 4) To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. 332 Technical data (ctd.) Tyre pressure in bar / psi1) Estate 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. Tyre pressure for full load Engine3) Tyres Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear Z 13 DTH 195/65 R 15, 205/55 R 16 2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 185/65 R 15, 195/60 R 15 2.3/33 2.1/30 – – 2.5/36 2.9/42 T 115/70 R 16 (temporary spare)4) 4.2/61 4.2/61 – – 4.2/61 4.2/61 all 1) Tyre pressure Tyre pressure for load of up to ECO2) loaded up to 3 people 3 persons 2) 3) 4) To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. Technical data (ctd.) Tyre pressure in bar / psi1) Estate Tyre pressure ECO2) loaded up to 3 people Tyre pressure for full load Tyres Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear Z 17 DTH 195/65 R 15, 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.5/36 2.3/33 – – 2.6/38 3.0/44 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42 215/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 2.7/39 2.5/36 – – 2.8/41 3.1/45 T 115/70 R 16 (temporary spare)4) 4.2/61 4.2/61 – – 4.2/61 4.2/61 all 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. Tyre pressure for load of up to 3 persons Engine3) Z 19 DT, Z 19 DTH 1) 333 2) 3) 4) To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. 334 Technical data (ctd.) Tyre pressure in bar / psi1) TwinTop Tyre pressure for full load Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear Z 16 XEP, Z 18 XE 205/55 R 16 225/45 R 17 2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.2/32 2.6/38 225/40 R 18 2.3/33 2.1/30 – – 2.4/35 2.8/41 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.3/33 2.1/30 – – 2.4/35 2.8/41 225/40 R 18 2.5/36 2.3/33 – – 2.6/38 3.0/44 205/55 R 16 225/45 R 17 2.5/36 2.3/33 – – 2.6/38 3.0/44 225/40 R 18 2.6/38 2.4/35 – – 2.7/39 3.1/45 205/55 R 16, 225/45 R 17 2.3/33 2.1/30 – – 2.4/35 2.8/41 225/40 R 18 2.5/36 2.3/33 – – 2.6/38 3.0/44 T 115/70 R 16 (temporary spare)4) 4.2/61 4.2/61 – – 4.2/61 4.2/61 Z 20 LER Z 19 DTH all 1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi. Tyre pressure ECO2) loaded up to 3 people Engine3) Z 20 LEL 1) Tyre pressure for load of up to 3 persons 2) 3) 4) To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres. Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 250. Technical data Electrical system Battery, Voltage 12 Volt Amp hours 36 Ah / 44 Ah 3 / 55 Ah 3 / 60 Ah 3 / 66 Ah 3 / 70 Ah 3 Battery for remote control of central locking system and electronic key of Open&Start system CR 20 32 335 336 Technical data Capacities (approx. litre) Engine1) Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Fuel tank (nominal content) 52 52 52 52 52 Engine oil with filter change between MIN and MAX on dipstick 3.5 1.0 4.5 1.0 4.5 1.0 4.25 1.0 4.25 1.0 Wash fluid reservoir for windscreen wash system with headlight wash system 2.4 4.0 2.4 4.0 2.4 4.0 2.4 4.0 2.4 4.0 1) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. Technical data Capacities (approx. litre) Engine1) Z 20 LEH VXR Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH Fuel tank (nominal content) 52 52 52 52 52 Engine oil with filter change between MIN and MAX on dipstick 5.0 1.0 3.2 1.0 5.0 1.0 4.3 1.0 4.3 1.0 Wash fluid reservoir for windscreen wash system with headlight wash system 2.4 4.0 2.4 4.0 2.4 4.0 2.4 4.0 2.4 4.0 1) Sales designation – see pages 308, 309. 337 338 Technical data Dimensions (approx. mm) Hatchback 5-door Hatchback 3-door Estate TwinTop Overall length 4249 4290 4515 4476 Width 1753 1753 1753 1759 Width with two exterior mirrors 2033 2033 2033 2039 Overall height 1460 1435 1500 1411 2614 2614 2703 2614 11.20 11.20 11.50 11.20 Wheelbase Turning circle diameter 1) In metres. 1) Technical data Installation dimensions of trailer towing equipment with detachable coupling ball bar, Hatchback1) All dimensions refer to factory-fitted towing equipment. Dimension mm A 342.9 B 83 C 513.4 D 488.6 E 211.4 F 94.3 G 160 9 Warning Only use towing equipment approved for your vehicle. We recommend entrusting retro-fitting of towing equipment to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 1) Do not mount towing equipment to vehicles with Z 20 LEH engine. Sales designation – see page 308. 339 340 Technical data Installation dimensions of trailer towing equipment with detachable coupling ball bar, Estate All dimensions refer to factory-fitted towing equipment. Dimension mm A 84.0 B 570.0 C 515.0 D 93.5 E 173.0 F 307.6 G 158.0 H 292.6 9 Warning Only use towing equipment approved for your vehicle. We recommend entrusting retro-fitting of towing equipment to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Technical data Installation dimensions of trailer towing equipment with detachable coupling ball bar, Astra TwinTop All measurements refer to Vauxhallapproved towing equipment. Dimension mm A 68.8 B 570.0 C 515.0 D 485.0 E 93.5 F 288.0 G 245.0 9 Warning Only use towing equipment approved for your vehicle. We recommend entrusting retro-fitting of towing equipment to your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. 341 342 Index Index A ABS (Anti-lock Brake System)................ 224 Accessories..............................128, 133, 248 Accessory socket .................................... 106 Adaptive Forward Lighting (AFL) ......... 137 Bulb replacement ............................... 272 Driving abroad.................................... 140 Air conditioning system ................. 153, 160 Air intake................................................. 173 Air quality sensor.................................... 168 Air recirculation system..........160, 164, 172 Air vents .................................................. 155 Airbags.................................................... 116 Alarm system ............................................ 83 Alternator.................................................. 39 Antenna ............................................ 64, 303 Anti-freeze protection.................... 294, 299 Anti-knock quality of fuel ...................... 200 Octane number........................... 308, 309 Anti-theft locking system ......................... 76 Towing equipment ............................. 237 Anti-theft protection ................................ 24 Aquaplaning........................................... 230 Armrest........................................89, 90, 108 Ashtray............................................ 106, 140 Automatic anti-dazzle interior mirror... 132 Automatic air recirculation mode . 168, 172 Automatic transmission.....20, 21, 182, 188 Automatic mode ........................ 183, 189 Control indicator......................... 184, 191 Driving programme.................... 184, 191 Fault ............................................ 186, 194 Interruption of power supply ..... 187, 195 Kickdown..................................... 185, 192 Manual mode ..................................... 190 Selector lever.......... 20, 21, 183, 189, 190 Winter programme..................... 185, 192 Automatic wiping..................................... 17 Index B C Battery .................................... 197, 300, 335 Interruption of power supply.............. 143, 180, 187, 195 Battery discharge protection................. 140 Before starting-off .................................... 22 Belt tensioners......................................... 111 Bleeding, diesel fuel system................... 243 Board information display ....................... 46 Bonnet ....................................................... 86 Boot, see Luggage compartment .....81, 91 Brake assist ............................................. 222 Brake light ............................................... 222 Brake system............................................. 38 Brakes ...................................................... 222 ABS....................................................... 224 Brake assist ......................................... 222 Brake fluid ........................................... 296 Brake lights..................................276, 282 Brake servo unit .................................. 196 Footbrake ............................................ 222 Handbrake .......................................... 223 Bulb replacement ...........................266, 268 Bulbs ....................................... 133, 266, 268 Capacities ....................................... 336, 337 Car Pass ...................................................... 2 Caravan / trailer towing................. 196, 234 Cargo box ............................................... 102 Catalytic converter .................203, 207, 243 Central locking system............................. 76 Changing the battery Radio frequency remote control ........................69, 75, 335 Changing tyre / wheel type ................... 226 Changing wheels .................................... 252 Chassis number, see Vehicle Identification Number ...... 307 Check control ...................................... 30, 62 Child restraint system..................... 128, 133 Child safety locks.............................. 86, 142 Cigarette lighter ............................. 105, 140 Climate control ....................................... 153 Climate control system .................. 154, 167 Clock .......................................................... 44 Clutch operation..................................... 197 CO2 emissions ......................................... 313 Code numbers ............................................ 2 Cold start ................................................ 197 Colour information display ...................... 46 Continuous Damping Control.......... 39, 210 Contrast..................................................... 57 343 Control indicators............................... 10, 37 ABS (Anti-lock Brake System)............ 225 Airbag ......................................... 121, 130 Adaptive Forward Lighting ......... 42, 137 Belt tensioners .................................... 112 Brake system....................................... 224 Cruise control...................................... 212 DDS...................................................... 217 Deflation detection system................ 217 Engine electronics............................... 206 ESP (Electronic Stability Programme) 208 Exhaust................................................ 205 IDS+.............................................. 210, 211 Immobiliser............................................ 67 Parking distance sensors ................... 215 Transmission ............................... 184, 191 Tyre pressure monitoring system ...... 220 Coolant ................................................... 294 Coolant level........................................... 295 Coolant temperature ............................... 39 Cooled glove compartment .................. 155 Cooling ............................................ 161, 166 Correcting time................................... 50, 56 Coupling socket load ............................. 240 Courtesy light ......................................... 139 Courtesy lights Bulb replacement ............................... 286 Cruise control.......................................... 212 Curtain airbags ...................................... 120 Curve lighting (AFL) ......................... 33, 137 344 Index D E F Data...................................................66, 306 Date .....................................................48, 51 Daytime running lights........................... 134 Decommissioning ................................... 301 Deflation Detection System .............32, 217 Demisting and defrosting Windows .............................................. 159 With climate control system............... 170 With air conditioning system .....162, 166 Diesel fuel filter ....................................... 294 Diesel fuel system ...........................243, 294 Diesel particle filter...................42, 156, 197 Dipped beam ....................................15, 134 Bulb replacement........................269, 272 Display.................................................43, 46 Display mode ............................................ 58 Door handle lighting .............................. 140 Door locks..........................................66, 305 Doors ......................................................... 38 Door-to-door lighting function .............. 138 Driving abroad................................200, 289 Headlights ........................................... 140 Driving hints ............................................ 196 Easy Load ............................................... 103 Easytronic.......................................... 20, 174 Driving programmes .......................... 176 Fault..................................................... 180 Interruption of power supply ............. 180 Kickdown............................................. 178 Selector lever......................................... 20 Starting-off.......................................... 175 Winter programme ............................. 177 Economical driving ......................... 196, 198 Electric windows ..................................... 141 Electrical system .....................260, 300, 335 Electro-hydraulic power-assisted steering ....................... 196 Electro-hydraulic power-assisted steering fluid...................................................... 307 Electronic components........................... 300 Electronic immobiliser .............................. 67 Electronic Stability Programme ............. 208 Engine code ............................307, 308, 309 Engine control indicator......................... 206 Engine speed .......................................... 197 Engine wash............................................ 305 Entry lighting........................................... 140 Environmental protection .............. 293, 302 Exhaust control indicator....................... 205 Exhaust gases......................................... 206 Exhaust system ....................................... 206 Exterior mirrors ...........................6, 131, 156 Fan ..........................................157, 291, 292 Filling station Capacities ................................... 336, 337 Engine oil level .................................... 292 Fuel ......................................200, 308, 309 Ignition key ..............................................2 Opening the bonnet............................. 86 Tyre pressure .............................. 199, 326 Vehicle data........................................ 307 Windscreen wash system................... 299 First-aid kit (cushion) ..................... 133, 248 Flat tyre................................................... 256 FlexOrganizer ......................................... 101 Front fog lights ....................................... 135 Bulb replacement ............................... 275 Fog tail light............................................ 135 Bulb replacement ....................... 276, 282 Folding roof, see TwinTop ..................... 146 Footbrake ............................................... 222 Front passenger’s airbag ...................... 116 Fuel..................................200, 201, 308, 309 Fuel consumption...................198, 200, 313 Fuel filler cap .......................................... 201 Fuel filter ................................................. 294 Fuel gauge................................................ 45 Fuel system, diesel ................................. 243 Fuses ....................................................... 260 Index 345 G H I Gears ......................................................... 20 Generator, see Alternator ........................ 39 Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories ..............................26, 133 Glasses compartment ............................ 108 Glove compartment ............................... 108 Glove compartment lighting.................. 140 Bulb replacement................................ 287 Graphical Information Display ................ 46 Gross Vehicle Weight.............................. 318 Halogen headlight system .................... 268 Bulb replacement ............................... 268 Driving abroad.................................... 140 Handbrake..................................23, 24, 223 Hazard warning lights ..................... 16, 132 Head restraints ...................28, 88, 132, 133 Headlight flash ......................................... 15 Headlight range adjustment......... 136, 268 Headlight switch.......................14, 134, 135 Headlight wash system.................... 18, 299 Headlights................................................. 14 Daytime running lights....................... 134 Driving abroad.................................... 140 Front fog lights ................................... 135 Reversing lights................................... 135 Warning device..................................... 23 Heated exterior mirrors.................... 18, 156 Heated front seats ................................. 156 Heated rear window ........................ 18, 156 Heating ........................................... 153, 158 Seats .................................................... 156 With climate control system .............. 169 With air conditioning system ..... 162, 166 Height adjustment Seat belts............................................. 113 Steering wheel......................................... 7 High-pressure cleaners ..........238, 304, 305 Hill Start Assist ........................................ 223 Horn........................................................... 16 Identification plate................................. 306 IDS+ (Interactive Driving System).. 208, 210 If you have a problem ..................... 26, 288 Ignition logic ....................................... 51, 58 Ignition system ............................... 291, 300 Immobiliser ............................................... 67 Information display.................................. 46 Infotainment system ................................ 65 Instrument display ................................... 45 Instrument illumination .......................... 138 Bulb replacement ............................... 287 Instrument panel .........................................7 Instruments ............................................... 36 Interactive Driving System (IDS+).. 208, 210 Interior mirror...............................................6 Interruption of power supply..... 60, 63, 143 Easytronic............................................ 180 Electric windows ................................. 143 Selector lever lock....................... 187, 195 ISO-FIX .................................................... 127 J Jack ......................................................... 251 Jump leads.............................................. 244 346 Index K M O Key Extending .............................................. 66 Ignition lock ........................................... 14 Locking doors........................................ 76 Remove.................................................. 24 Starting the engine .........................14, 22 Key numbers ............................................... 2 Keys ........................................................... 66 Main beam........................................ 15, 134 Bulb replacement ....................... 270, 272 Control indicator................................... 40 Maintenance..................................... 26, 290 Air conditioning system...................... 173 Anti-freeze protection ........................ 294 Brake fluid ........................................... 296 Brakes .................................................. 222 Catalytic converter ............................. 207 Engine oil..................................... 292, 293 Fuel consumption ............................... 199 Tyre pressure....................................... 228 Tyres ............................................ 229, 230 Windscreen wiper ............................... 297 Manual transmission, see Transmission . 20 Mirrors ................................................. 6, 131 Misted windows .............................. 159, 170 Mobile telephone...................................... 65 Motorway lighting (AFL).................. 33, 137 Octane numbers............................. 200, 308 Oil change .............................................. 293 Oil filter change...................................... 293 Oil level and consumption............... 39, 292 Oil pressure ............................................... 37 Oils........................................................... 292 Open&Start system ................ 22, 31, 36, 70 Operating temperature ......................... 197 Outside temperature gauge ................... 47 Overrun ........................................... 197, 199 L Language selection ............................51, 56 Lashing eyes ........................................... 102 Leather trim ............................................ 304 Level control system............................... 216 Lighting switch.......................................... 14 Lighting .......................................14, 39, 134 Driving abroad.................................... 140 Loading .................................. 239, 316, 317 Locking doors ....................................... 2, 76 Locking from the inside............................ 78 Locks........................................................ 305 Lubricants .......................................292, 307 Luggage compartment............................ 81 Bulb replacement................................ 287 FlexOrganizer...................................... 101 Lighting ............................................... 140 Loading .............................. 104, 239, 318 Locking .................................................. 81 Safety net .............................................. 99 Luggage compartment cover ........... 97, 98 Lumbar support.......................................... 4 N Neutral, transmission ............................... 20 Number plate lights Bulb replacement ............................... 285 Number plate lighting............................ 285 Number plates........................................ 301 P Paintwork damage................................. 304 Panoramic windscreen..................... 34, 144 Parking distance sensors ....................... 214 Parking .............................................. 24, 214 Parking lights.................................... 14, 138 Bulb replacement ....................... 271, 274 Parts .................................................. 26, 133 Pedals...................................................... 197 Performance ........................................... 313 Petrol .......................................200, 308, 309 Pinking..................................................... 200 Pollen filter .............................................. 173 Power assisted steering, see electro-hydraulic power assisted steering........... 196 Power steering, see electro-hydraulic power assisted steering .............................. 196 Preheating .......................................... 22, 42 Preheating switch..................................... 22 Puddle light............................................. 140 Pushing, towing ...................................... 243 Index Q S Quickheat ............................... 158, 165, 169 Safeguard against unauthorised use .......................... 2, 14, 25 Safety accessories ..................128, 133, 248 Safety net.................................................. 99 Safety systems ........................................ 109 Saving energy ......................................... 198 Seat adjustment ......................................... 3 Seat belts ................................110, 113, 304 Seat height adjustment ............................. 4 Seating position........................................ 87 Seat occupancy recognition.................. 122 Seats ........................................................ 3, 4 Heated seats....................................... 156 Selector lever...........................175, 183, 189 Selector lever lock...............20, 21, 183, 189 Self-diagnosis .........................112, 121, 225 Self-help .................................................. 243 Automatic transmission ..................... 187 Electric sunroof ................................... 145 Electric windows.................................. 143 Information display .............................. 48 Radio frequency remote control ... 69, 75 Service interval display .......................... 290 Service work ................................26, 44, 290 Side airbags ............................................ 118 Signal system ...................................... 15, 16 Spare keys................................................. 66 Spare wheel ............................249, 250, 252 Speed............................................... 198, 199 Fuel consumption ....................... 198, 199 Speedometer ............................................ 45 Sport mode ............................................... 39 R Radio ......................................................... 64 Radio equipment (CB).............................. 65 Radio reception ........................................ 64 Radio frequency remote control Central locking system .........2, 31, 68, 71 Rain sensor........................................17, 297 Reading lights ......................................... 139 Rear light cluster..................................... 134 Bulb replacement........................276, 282 Rear window wash system.......18, 299, 303 Refuelling................................................. 201 Fuel filler cap....................................... 202 Remote control Central locking system .........2, 31, 68, 71 Steering wheel.................................30, 64 Replacement keys .................................... 66 Reversing lights Bulb replacement........................276, 282 Rollover protection system .................... 151 Roof lining .........................................34, 144 Roof load................ 105, 196, 199, 316, 317 Roof racks .............................. 199, 234, 318 Run-flat tyres .......................................... 231 Running-in ............................................... 196 Brakes .................................................. 222 347 Sport programme............................. 32, 210 Starter switch ............................................ 14 Starting the engine ............14, 67, 174, 243 Self-help .............................................. 243 Steam-jet cleaners .................238, 304, 305 Steering column lock.......................... 14, 24 Steering wheel adjustment .........................7 Steering wheel remote control .......... 30, 64 Stowage compartments ........................ 108 Sunroof.................................................... 144 Sunvisors ................................... 34, 140, 144 Sunblind .................................................. 145 System settings................................... 50, 55 348 Index T Tables ...................................................... 108 Tachometer............................................... 45 Tail lights ................................................. 134 Bulb replacement........................276, 282 Tailgate ..................................................... 81 Tank Fuel gauge ............................................ 45 Technical data ........................................ 306 Telephone, see Mobile telephone ........... 65 Temperature regulation.................157, 169 Tempomat, see cruise control ............... 212 Temporary spare wheel .................233, 250 The first 600 miles................................... 196 Tightening torque...........................255, 326 Time .....................................................48, 51 Tools ........................................................ 251 Towing ..................................................... 245 Towing equipment ................................. 235 Towing eye ......................................245, 247 Trailer Stability Assist (TSA)................... 240 Transmission display ....... 43, 174, 182, 189 Transmission, automatic... 20, 21, 182, 188 Automatic mode.........................183, 189 Driving programme ....................184, 191 Fault.............................................186, 194 Interruption of power supply .....187, 195 Kickdown .....................................185, 192 Selector lever ................ 20, 183, 189, 190 Selector lever lock ................................. 20 Winter programme .....................185, 192 Transmission, Easytronic ....................... 174 Driving programmes .......................... 176 Fault..................................................... 180 Interruption of power supply ............. 180 Kickdown............................................. 178 Selector lever................................. 20, 175 Winter programme ............................. 177 Transmission, manual .............................. 20 Tread depth ............................................ 230 Trip computer ............................... 30, 52, 58 Trip odometer..................................... 44, 45 Triple Information Display ....................... 46 TSA (Trailer Stability Assist)................... 240 Turn signal lights ..................................... 15 Bulb replacement ...............275, 276, 282 Twin Audio .......................................... 31, 64 TwinTop .................................................. 146 Closing the roof .................................. 147 Opening the roof ................................ 147 Rollover protection ............................. 151 Warning buzzers................................. 148 Wind deflector .................................... 149 Tyre chains...................................... 232, 326 Tyre condition......................................... 229 Tyre pressure ................... 32, 218, 228, 326 Tyre pressure monitoring system .......... 218 Tyre repair kit ......................................... 256 U Units of measure ................................ 51, 57 Unleaded fuel .........................200, 203, 308 Used oil ................................................... 293 V Valve cap key ................................. 228, 326 Vauxhall alarm system ............................ 83 Vehicle care ............................................ 302 Vehicle decommissioning ...................... 301 Vehicle Identification Number .............. 307 Vehicle keys, see Keys ............................. 66 Vehicle recommissioning ....................... 301 Vehicle tools ........................................... 251 Ventilation ......................153, 158, 165, 171 Index W Warning buzzers....................................... 23 Warning messages .......................49, 54, 55 Warning triangle.............................133, 248 Wash fluid reservoir, windscreen wash system...................... 299 Weights............................................316, 317 Wheels, tyres ........................................... 226 Wind deflector ........................................ 149 Windows Demisting and defrosting ........... 159, 162, 166, 170 Windscreen wash system ......................... 18 Anti-freeze protection ........................ 299 Capacities....................................336, 337 Wash fluid reservoir ............................ 299 Windscreen wiper .............................17, 297 Winter mode Starting-off aid ................................... 177 Winter operation Battery ................................................. 197 Coolant, anti-freeze............................ 294 Fuel consumption ............................... 199 Fuel for diesel engines........................ 201 Heating............................... 153, 162, 166 Locks .................................................... 305 Tyre chains ..................................232, 326 Window demisting and defrosting .... 159 Windscreen wash system, anti-freeze protection......................... 299 Winter programme ................ 177, 185, 192 Winter tyres .....................................232, 326 X Xenon headlight system ........................ 272 Bulb replacement ............................... 272 Driving abroad.................................... 140 349 Owner’s Manual ASTRA Operation, Safety and Maintenance Reproduction or translation, in whole or in parts, is not permitted without prior written consent from Vauxhall Motors Ltd. All rights as understood under the copyright laws are explicitly reserved by Vauxhall Motors Ltd. All information, illustrations and specifications contained in this manual are based on the latest production information available at the time of publication. The right is reserved to make changes at any time without notice. Edition: January 2006. TS 1612-B-06 A ST R A ©Copyright by Vauxhall Motors Ltd., England.